elf.c revision 1.13.2.1 1 1.1 skrll /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2 1.1 skrll
3 1.9 christos Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 1.1 skrll
5 1.1 skrll This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 1.1 skrll
7 1.1 skrll This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 1.1 skrll it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 1.1 skrll the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 1.1 skrll (at your option) any later version.
11 1.1 skrll
12 1.1 skrll This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 1.1 skrll but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 1.1 skrll MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 1.1 skrll GNU General Public License for more details.
16 1.1 skrll
17 1.1 skrll You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 1.1 skrll along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 1.1 skrll Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 1.1 skrll MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21 1.1 skrll
22 1.1 skrll
23 1.1 skrll /*
24 1.1 skrll SECTION
25 1.1 skrll ELF backends
26 1.1 skrll
27 1.1 skrll BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 1.1 skrll Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 1.1 skrll (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30 1.1 skrll
31 1.1 skrll Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 1.1 skrll to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 1.1 skrll haven't bothered yet. */
34 1.1 skrll
35 1.1 skrll /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 1.1 skrll #define _SYSCALL32
37 1.1 skrll #include "sysdep.h"
38 1.1 skrll #include "bfd.h"
39 1.1 skrll #include "bfdlink.h"
40 1.1 skrll #include "libbfd.h"
41 1.1 skrll #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 1.1 skrll #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 1.1 skrll #include "libiberty.h"
44 1.1 skrll #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 1.7 christos #include "elf-linux-core.h"
46 1.1 skrll
47 1.3 christos #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 1.3 christos #include CORE_HEADER
49 1.3 christos #endif
50 1.3 christos
51 1.1 skrll static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
56 1.9 christos size_t align) ;
57 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 1.9 christos file_ptr offset, size_t align);
59 1.1 skrll
60 1.1 skrll /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 1.1 skrll currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 1.1 skrll need to move into elfcode.h. */
63 1.1 skrll
64 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
65 1.1 skrll
66 1.1 skrll void
67 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
70 1.1 skrll {
71 1.1 skrll dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 1.1 skrll dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 1.1 skrll dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 1.1 skrll dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 1.1 skrll dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 1.1 skrll dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 1.1 skrll dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
78 1.1 skrll }
79 1.1 skrll
80 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
81 1.1 skrll
82 1.1 skrll void
83 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
86 1.1 skrll {
87 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
94 1.1 skrll }
95 1.1 skrll
96 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
97 1.1 skrll
98 1.1 skrll void
99 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
102 1.1 skrll {
103 1.1 skrll dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 1.1 skrll dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
105 1.1 skrll }
106 1.1 skrll
107 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
108 1.1 skrll
109 1.1 skrll void
110 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
113 1.1 skrll {
114 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
116 1.1 skrll }
117 1.1 skrll
118 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
119 1.1 skrll
120 1.1 skrll void
121 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
124 1.1 skrll {
125 1.1 skrll dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 1.1 skrll dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 1.1 skrll dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 1.1 skrll dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 1.1 skrll dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
130 1.1 skrll }
131 1.1 skrll
132 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
133 1.1 skrll
134 1.1 skrll void
135 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
138 1.1 skrll {
139 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
144 1.1 skrll }
145 1.1 skrll
146 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
147 1.1 skrll
148 1.1 skrll void
149 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
152 1.1 skrll {
153 1.1 skrll dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 1.1 skrll dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 1.1 skrll dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 1.1 skrll dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 1.1 skrll dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
158 1.1 skrll }
159 1.1 skrll
160 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
161 1.1 skrll
162 1.1 skrll void
163 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
166 1.1 skrll {
167 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
172 1.1 skrll }
173 1.1 skrll
174 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
175 1.1 skrll
176 1.1 skrll void
177 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
180 1.1 skrll {
181 1.1 skrll dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
182 1.1 skrll }
183 1.1 skrll
184 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
185 1.1 skrll
186 1.1 skrll void
187 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Versym *dst)
190 1.1 skrll {
191 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
192 1.1 skrll }
193 1.1 skrll
194 1.1 skrll /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 1.1 skrll cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
196 1.1 skrll
197 1.1 skrll unsigned long
198 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
199 1.1 skrll {
200 1.1 skrll const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
201 1.1 skrll unsigned long h = 0;
202 1.1 skrll unsigned long g;
203 1.1 skrll int ch;
204 1.1 skrll
205 1.1 skrll while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
206 1.1 skrll {
207 1.1 skrll h = (h << 4) + ch;
208 1.1 skrll if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
209 1.1 skrll {
210 1.1 skrll h ^= g >> 24;
211 1.1 skrll /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 1.1 skrll this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
213 1.1 skrll h ^= g;
214 1.1 skrll }
215 1.1 skrll }
216 1.1 skrll return h & 0xffffffff;
217 1.1 skrll }
218 1.1 skrll
219 1.1 skrll /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 1.1 skrll cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
221 1.1 skrll
222 1.1 skrll unsigned long
223 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
224 1.1 skrll {
225 1.1 skrll const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 1.1 skrll unsigned long h = 5381;
227 1.1 skrll unsigned char ch;
228 1.1 skrll
229 1.1 skrll while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 1.1 skrll h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 1.1 skrll return h & 0xffffffff;
232 1.1 skrll }
233 1.1 skrll
234 1.1 skrll /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 1.1 skrll the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
236 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
237 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
238 1.1 skrll size_t object_size,
239 1.3 christos enum elf_target_id object_id)
240 1.1 skrll {
241 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 1.1 skrll abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 1.1 skrll if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
244 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
245 1.1 skrll
246 1.1 skrll elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 1.6 christos if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
248 1.6 christos {
249 1.6 christos struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
250 1.6 christos if (o == NULL)
251 1.6 christos return FALSE;
252 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
253 1.6 christos elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
254 1.6 christos }
255 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
256 1.1 skrll }
257 1.1 skrll
258 1.1 skrll
259 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
260 1.3 christos bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
261 1.1 skrll {
262 1.3 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
263 1.1 skrll return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
264 1.3 christos bed->target_id);
265 1.1 skrll }
266 1.1 skrll
267 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
268 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
269 1.1 skrll {
270 1.1 skrll /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
271 1.6 christos if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
272 1.6 christos return FALSE;
273 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
274 1.6 christos return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
275 1.1 skrll }
276 1.1 skrll
277 1.3 christos static char *
278 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
279 1.1 skrll {
280 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
281 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
282 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset;
283 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
284 1.1 skrll
285 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
286 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp == 0
287 1.1 skrll || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
288 1.1 skrll || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
289 1.1 skrll return NULL;
290 1.1 skrll
291 1.1 skrll shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
292 1.1 skrll if (shstrtab == NULL)
293 1.1 skrll {
294 1.1 skrll /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
295 1.1 skrll offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
296 1.1 skrll shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
297 1.1 skrll
298 1.1 skrll /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
299 1.1 skrll in case the string table is not terminated. */
300 1.1 skrll if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
301 1.13.2.1 martin || (bfd_get_file_size (abfd) > 0 /* not a character device */
302 1.13.2.1 martin && shstrtabsize > bfd_get_file_size (abfd))
303 1.6 christos || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
304 1.6 christos || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
305 1.1 skrll shstrtab = NULL;
306 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
307 1.1 skrll {
308 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
309 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
310 1.6 christos bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
311 1.1 skrll shstrtab = NULL;
312 1.1 skrll /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
313 1.1 skrll trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
314 1.1 skrll the string table over and over. */
315 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
316 1.1 skrll }
317 1.1 skrll else
318 1.1 skrll shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
319 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
320 1.1 skrll }
321 1.1 skrll return (char *) shstrtab;
322 1.1 skrll }
323 1.1 skrll
324 1.1 skrll char *
325 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
326 1.1 skrll unsigned int shindex,
327 1.1 skrll unsigned int strindex)
328 1.1 skrll {
329 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
330 1.1 skrll
331 1.1 skrll if (strindex == 0)
332 1.1 skrll return "";
333 1.1 skrll
334 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
335 1.1 skrll return NULL;
336 1.1 skrll
337 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
338 1.1 skrll
339 1.6 christos if (hdr->contents == NULL)
340 1.6 christos {
341 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
342 1.6 christos {
343 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
344 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
345 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
346 1.9 christos " a non-string section (number %d)"),
347 1.6 christos abfd, shindex);
348 1.6 christos return NULL;
349 1.6 christos }
350 1.6 christos
351 1.6 christos if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
352 1.6 christos return NULL;
353 1.6 christos }
354 1.1 skrll
355 1.1 skrll if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
356 1.1 skrll {
357 1.1 skrll unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
358 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
359 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
360 1.13 christos (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
361 1.13 christos abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
362 1.1 skrll (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
363 1.1 skrll ? ".shstrtab"
364 1.1 skrll : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
365 1.3 christos return NULL;
366 1.1 skrll }
367 1.1 skrll
368 1.1 skrll return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
369 1.1 skrll }
370 1.1 skrll
371 1.1 skrll /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
372 1.1 skrll SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
373 1.1 skrll symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
374 1.1 skrll are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
375 1.1 skrll symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
376 1.1 skrll Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
377 1.1 skrll or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
378 1.1 skrll
379 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *
380 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
381 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
382 1.1 skrll size_t symcount,
383 1.1 skrll size_t symoffset,
384 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
385 1.1 skrll void *extsym_buf,
386 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
387 1.1 skrll {
388 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
389 1.1 skrll void *alloc_ext;
390 1.1 skrll const bfd_byte *esym;
391 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
392 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
393 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
394 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
395 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
396 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
397 1.1 skrll size_t extsym_size;
398 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
399 1.1 skrll file_ptr pos;
400 1.1 skrll
401 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
402 1.1 skrll abort ();
403 1.1 skrll
404 1.1 skrll if (symcount == 0)
405 1.1 skrll return intsym_buf;
406 1.1 skrll
407 1.1 skrll /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
408 1.1 skrll shndx_hdr = NULL;
409 1.6 christos if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
410 1.6 christos {
411 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
412 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
413 1.6 christos
414 1.6 christos /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
415 1.6 christos for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
416 1.7 christos {
417 1.7 christos /* PR 20063. */
418 1.7 christos if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
419 1.7 christos continue;
420 1.7 christos
421 1.7 christos if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
422 1.7 christos {
423 1.7 christos shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
424 1.7 christos break;
425 1.7 christos };
426 1.7 christos }
427 1.6 christos
428 1.6 christos if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
429 1.6 christos {
430 1.6 christos if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
431 1.6 christos /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
432 1.6 christos shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
433 1.6 christos /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
434 1.6 christos the index table will not be needed. */
435 1.6 christos }
436 1.6 christos }
437 1.1 skrll
438 1.1 skrll /* Read the symbols. */
439 1.1 skrll alloc_ext = NULL;
440 1.1 skrll alloc_extshndx = NULL;
441 1.1 skrll alloc_intsym = NULL;
442 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
443 1.1 skrll extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
444 1.7 christos amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
445 1.1 skrll pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
446 1.1 skrll if (extsym_buf == NULL)
447 1.1 skrll {
448 1.1 skrll alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
449 1.1 skrll extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
450 1.1 skrll }
451 1.1 skrll if (extsym_buf == NULL
452 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
453 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
454 1.1 skrll {
455 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
456 1.1 skrll goto out;
457 1.1 skrll }
458 1.1 skrll
459 1.1 skrll if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
460 1.1 skrll extshndx_buf = NULL;
461 1.1 skrll else
462 1.1 skrll {
463 1.7 christos amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
464 1.1 skrll pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
465 1.1 skrll if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
466 1.1 skrll {
467 1.3 christos alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
468 1.9 christos bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
469 1.1 skrll extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
470 1.1 skrll }
471 1.1 skrll if (extshndx_buf == NULL
472 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
473 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
474 1.1 skrll {
475 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
476 1.1 skrll goto out;
477 1.1 skrll }
478 1.1 skrll }
479 1.1 skrll
480 1.1 skrll if (intsym_buf == NULL)
481 1.1 skrll {
482 1.3 christos alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
483 1.9 christos bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
484 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
485 1.1 skrll if (intsym_buf == NULL)
486 1.1 skrll goto out;
487 1.1 skrll }
488 1.1 skrll
489 1.1 skrll /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
490 1.1 skrll isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
491 1.3 christos for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
492 1.9 christos shndx = extshndx_buf;
493 1.1 skrll isym < isymend;
494 1.1 skrll esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
495 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
496 1.1 skrll {
497 1.1 skrll symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
498 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
499 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
500 1.9 christos " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
501 1.9 christos ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
502 1.1 skrll if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
503 1.1 skrll free (alloc_intsym);
504 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
505 1.1 skrll goto out;
506 1.1 skrll }
507 1.1 skrll
508 1.1 skrll out:
509 1.1 skrll if (alloc_ext != NULL)
510 1.1 skrll free (alloc_ext);
511 1.1 skrll if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
512 1.1 skrll free (alloc_extshndx);
513 1.1 skrll
514 1.1 skrll return intsym_buf;
515 1.1 skrll }
516 1.1 skrll
517 1.1 skrll /* Look up a symbol name. */
518 1.1 skrll const char *
519 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
520 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
521 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
522 1.1 skrll asection *sym_sec)
523 1.1 skrll {
524 1.1 skrll const char *name;
525 1.1 skrll unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
526 1.1 skrll unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
527 1.1 skrll
528 1.1 skrll if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
529 1.1 skrll /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
530 1.1 skrll && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
531 1.1 skrll {
532 1.1 skrll iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
533 1.1 skrll shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
534 1.1 skrll }
535 1.1 skrll
536 1.1 skrll name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
537 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
538 1.1 skrll name = "(null)";
539 1.1 skrll else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
540 1.1 skrll name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
541 1.1 skrll
542 1.1 skrll return name;
543 1.1 skrll }
544 1.1 skrll
545 1.1 skrll /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
546 1.1 skrll sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
547 1.1 skrll pointers. */
548 1.1 skrll
549 1.1 skrll typedef union elf_internal_group {
550 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
551 1.1 skrll unsigned int flags;
552 1.1 skrll } Elf_Internal_Group;
553 1.1 skrll
554 1.1 skrll /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
555 1.1 skrll signature just a string? */
556 1.1 skrll
557 1.1 skrll static const char *
558 1.1 skrll group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
559 1.1 skrll {
560 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
561 1.1 skrll unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
562 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
563 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
564 1.1 skrll
565 1.1 skrll /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
566 1.1 skrll that it is a symbol table section. */
567 1.1 skrll if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
568 1.1 skrll return NULL;
569 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
570 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
571 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
572 1.1 skrll return NULL;
573 1.1 skrll
574 1.1 skrll /* Go read the symbol. */
575 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
576 1.1 skrll if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
577 1.1 skrll &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
578 1.1 skrll return NULL;
579 1.1 skrll
580 1.1 skrll return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
581 1.1 skrll }
582 1.1 skrll
583 1.1 skrll /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
584 1.1 skrll
585 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
586 1.1 skrll setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
587 1.1 skrll {
588 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
589 1.1 skrll
590 1.1 skrll /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
591 1.1 skrll is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
592 1.1 skrll if (num_group == 0)
593 1.1 skrll {
594 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, shnum;
595 1.1 skrll
596 1.1 skrll /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
597 1.1 skrll section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
598 1.1 skrll shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
599 1.1 skrll num_group = 0;
600 1.1 skrll
601 1.6 christos #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
602 1.1 skrll ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
603 1.6 christos && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
604 1.1 skrll && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
605 1.1 skrll && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
606 1.1 skrll
607 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
608 1.1 skrll {
609 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
610 1.1 skrll
611 1.6 christos if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
612 1.1 skrll num_group += 1;
613 1.1 skrll }
614 1.1 skrll
615 1.1 skrll if (num_group == 0)
616 1.1 skrll {
617 1.1 skrll num_group = (unsigned) -1;
618 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
619 1.9 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
620 1.1 skrll }
621 1.1 skrll else
622 1.1 skrll {
623 1.1 skrll /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
624 1.1 skrll so we can find them quickly. */
625 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
626 1.1 skrll
627 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
628 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
629 1.9 christos bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
630 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
631 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
632 1.13 christos memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0,
633 1.13 christos num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
634 1.9 christos num_group = 0;
635 1.1 skrll
636 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
637 1.1 skrll {
638 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
639 1.1 skrll
640 1.6 christos if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
641 1.1 skrll {
642 1.1 skrll unsigned char *src;
643 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
644 1.1 skrll
645 1.9 christos /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
646 1.9 christos attached to it. */
647 1.9 christos if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
648 1.9 christos return FALSE;
649 1.9 christos
650 1.1 skrll /* Add to list of sections. */
651 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
652 1.1 skrll num_group += 1;
653 1.1 skrll
654 1.1 skrll /* Read the raw contents. */
655 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
656 1.1 skrll amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
657 1.3 christos shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
658 1.9 christos bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
659 1.1 skrll /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
660 1.1 skrll if (shdr->contents == NULL)
661 1.1 skrll {
662 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
663 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
664 1.13 christos (_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
665 1.13 christos " header: %#" PRIx64),
666 1.13 christos abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
667 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
668 1.6 christos -- num_group;
669 1.6 christos continue;
670 1.1 skrll }
671 1.1 skrll
672 1.1 skrll memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
673 1.1 skrll
674 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
675 1.1 skrll || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
676 1.1 skrll != shdr->sh_size))
677 1.6 christos {
678 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler
679 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
680 1.13 christos (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
681 1.13 christos " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
682 1.13 christos abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
683 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
684 1.6 christos -- num_group;
685 1.9 christos /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
686 1.9 christos partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
687 1.9 christos contents to be used. */
688 1.6 christos memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
689 1.6 christos continue;
690 1.6 christos }
691 1.1 skrll
692 1.1 skrll /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
693 1.1 skrll array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
694 1.1 skrll to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
695 1.1 skrll pointers. */
696 1.1 skrll src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
697 1.1 skrll dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
698 1.6 christos
699 1.1 skrll while (1)
700 1.1 skrll {
701 1.1 skrll unsigned int idx;
702 1.1 skrll
703 1.1 skrll src -= 4;
704 1.1 skrll --dest;
705 1.1 skrll idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
706 1.1 skrll if (src == shdr->contents)
707 1.1 skrll {
708 1.1 skrll dest->flags = idx;
709 1.1 skrll if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
710 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->flags
711 1.1 skrll |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
712 1.1 skrll break;
713 1.1 skrll }
714 1.13 christos if (idx < shnum)
715 1.13 christos {
716 1.13 christos dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
717 1.13 christos /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
718 1.13 christos section group should be marked with
719 1.13 christos SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
720 1.13 christos broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
721 1.13 christos them up here. */
722 1.13 christos dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
723 1.13 christos }
724 1.13 christos if (idx >= shnum
725 1.13 christos || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
726 1.1 skrll {
727 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
728 1.13 christos (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
729 1.13 christos abfd, i);
730 1.13 christos dest->shdr = NULL;
731 1.1 skrll }
732 1.1 skrll }
733 1.1 skrll }
734 1.1 skrll }
735 1.6 christos
736 1.6 christos /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
737 1.6 christos if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
738 1.6 christos {
739 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
740 1.6 christos
741 1.6 christos /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
742 1.6 christos if (num_group == 0)
743 1.6 christos {
744 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
745 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
746 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
747 1.13 christos (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
748 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
749 1.6 christos }
750 1.6 christos }
751 1.1 skrll }
752 1.1 skrll }
753 1.1 skrll
754 1.1 skrll if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
755 1.1 skrll {
756 1.9 christos unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
757 1.9 christos unsigned int j;
758 1.1 skrll
759 1.9 christos for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
760 1.1 skrll {
761 1.9 christos /* Begin search from previous found group. */
762 1.9 christos unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
763 1.9 christos
764 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
765 1.9 christos Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
766 1.9 christos bfd_size_type n_elt;
767 1.9 christos
768 1.9 christos if (shdr == NULL)
769 1.9 christos continue;
770 1.9 christos
771 1.9 christos idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
772 1.9 christos if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
773 1.9 christos {
774 1.9 christos /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
775 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
776 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
777 1.9 christos abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
778 1.9 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
779 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
780 1.9 christos return FALSE;
781 1.9 christos }
782 1.9 christos n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
783 1.1 skrll
784 1.1 skrll /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
785 1.1 skrll section is a member. */
786 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
787 1.1 skrll if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
788 1.1 skrll {
789 1.1 skrll asection *s = NULL;
790 1.1 skrll
791 1.1 skrll /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
792 1.1 skrll other members to see if any others are linked via
793 1.1 skrll next_in_group. */
794 1.1 skrll idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
795 1.1 skrll n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
796 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
797 1.13 christos if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
798 1.13 christos && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
799 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
800 1.1 skrll break;
801 1.1 skrll if (n_elt != 0)
802 1.1 skrll {
803 1.1 skrll /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
804 1.1 skrll insert current section in circular list. */
805 1.1 skrll elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
806 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
807 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
808 1.1 skrll }
809 1.1 skrll else
810 1.1 skrll {
811 1.1 skrll const char *gname;
812 1.1 skrll
813 1.1 skrll gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
814 1.1 skrll if (gname == NULL)
815 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
816 1.1 skrll elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
817 1.1 skrll
818 1.1 skrll /* Start a circular list with one element. */
819 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
820 1.1 skrll }
821 1.1 skrll
822 1.1 skrll /* If the group section has been created, point to the
823 1.1 skrll new member. */
824 1.1 skrll if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
825 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
826 1.1 skrll
827 1.9 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
828 1.9 christos j = num_group - 1;
829 1.1 skrll break;
830 1.1 skrll }
831 1.1 skrll }
832 1.1 skrll }
833 1.1 skrll
834 1.1 skrll if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
835 1.1 skrll {
836 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
837 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
838 1.9 christos abfd, newsect);
839 1.6 christos return FALSE;
840 1.1 skrll }
841 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
842 1.1 skrll }
843 1.1 skrll
844 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
845 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
846 1.1 skrll {
847 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
848 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
849 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
850 1.1 skrll asection *s;
851 1.1 skrll
852 1.1 skrll /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
853 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
854 1.1 skrll {
855 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
856 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
857 1.1 skrll {
858 1.1 skrll unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
859 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
860 1.1 skrll not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
861 1.1 skrll get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
862 1.1 skrll if (elfsec == 0)
863 1.1 skrll {
864 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
865 1.1 skrll if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
866 1.1 skrll bed->link_order_error_handler
867 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
868 1.13 christos (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
869 1.1 skrll abfd, s);
870 1.1 skrll }
871 1.1 skrll else
872 1.1 skrll {
873 1.3 christos asection *linksec = NULL;
874 1.1 skrll
875 1.1 skrll if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
876 1.1 skrll {
877 1.1 skrll this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
878 1.3 christos linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
879 1.1 skrll }
880 1.1 skrll
881 1.1 skrll /* PR 1991, 2008:
882 1.1 skrll Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
883 1.1 skrll sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
884 1.3 christos if (linksec == NULL)
885 1.1 skrll {
886 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
887 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
888 1.13 christos (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
889 1.9 christos s->owner, elfsec, s);
890 1.1 skrll result = FALSE;
891 1.1 skrll }
892 1.1 skrll
893 1.3 christos elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
894 1.1 skrll }
895 1.1 skrll }
896 1.9 christos else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
897 1.9 christos && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
898 1.9 christos {
899 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
900 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
901 1.13 christos (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
902 1.9 christos abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
903 1.9 christos result = FALSE;
904 1.9 christos }
905 1.1 skrll }
906 1.1 skrll
907 1.1 skrll /* Process section groups. */
908 1.1 skrll if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
909 1.1 skrll return result;
910 1.1 skrll
911 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
912 1.1 skrll {
913 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
914 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
915 1.6 christos unsigned int n_elt;
916 1.6 christos
917 1.6 christos /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
918 1.6 christos if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
919 1.6 christos {
920 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
921 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
922 1.13 christos (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
923 1.6 christos abfd, i);
924 1.6 christos result = FALSE;
925 1.6 christos continue;
926 1.6 christos }
927 1.6 christos
928 1.6 christos idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
929 1.6 christos n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
930 1.1 skrll
931 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
932 1.9 christos {
933 1.9 christos ++ idx;
934 1.9 christos
935 1.9 christos if (idx->shdr == NULL)
936 1.9 christos continue;
937 1.9 christos else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
938 1.9 christos elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
939 1.9 christos else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
940 1.9 christos && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
941 1.9 christos {
942 1.9 christos /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
943 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
944 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
945 1.13 christos (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
946 1.9 christos abfd,
947 1.9 christos idx->shdr->sh_type,
948 1.9 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
949 1.9 christos (elf_elfheader (abfd)
950 1.9 christos ->e_shstrndx),
951 1.9 christos idx->shdr->sh_name),
952 1.9 christos shdr->bfd_section);
953 1.9 christos result = FALSE;
954 1.9 christos }
955 1.9 christos }
956 1.1 skrll }
957 1.9 christos
958 1.1 skrll return result;
959 1.1 skrll }
960 1.1 skrll
961 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
962 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
963 1.1 skrll {
964 1.1 skrll return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
965 1.1 skrll }
966 1.1 skrll
967 1.6 christos static char *
968 1.6 christos convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
969 1.6 christos {
970 1.6 christos unsigned int len = strlen (name);
971 1.6 christos char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
972 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
973 1.6 christos return NULL;
974 1.6 christos new_name[0] = '.';
975 1.6 christos new_name[1] = 'z';
976 1.6 christos memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
977 1.6 christos return new_name;
978 1.6 christos }
979 1.6 christos
980 1.6 christos static char *
981 1.6 christos convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
982 1.6 christos {
983 1.6 christos unsigned int len = strlen (name);
984 1.6 christos char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
985 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
986 1.6 christos return NULL;
987 1.6 christos new_name[0] = '.';
988 1.6 christos memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
989 1.6 christos return new_name;
990 1.6 christos }
991 1.6 christos
992 1.1 skrll /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
993 1.1 skrll BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
994 1.1 skrll
995 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
996 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
997 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
998 1.1 skrll const char *name,
999 1.1 skrll int shindex)
1000 1.1 skrll {
1001 1.1 skrll asection *newsect;
1002 1.1 skrll flagword flags;
1003 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1004 1.1 skrll
1005 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1006 1.3 christos return TRUE;
1007 1.1 skrll
1008 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1009 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
1010 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1011 1.1 skrll
1012 1.1 skrll hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1013 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1014 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1015 1.1 skrll
1016 1.1 skrll /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1017 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1018 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1019 1.1 skrll
1020 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1021 1.1 skrll
1022 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1023 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1024 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1025 1.1 skrll bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1026 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1027 1.1 skrll
1028 1.1 skrll flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1029 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1030 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1031 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1032 1.9 christos flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1033 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1034 1.1 skrll {
1035 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1036 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1037 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1038 1.1 skrll }
1039 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1040 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1041 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1042 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_CODE;
1043 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1044 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_DATA;
1045 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1046 1.1 skrll {
1047 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1048 1.1 skrll newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1049 1.1 skrll }
1050 1.7 christos if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1051 1.7 christos flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1052 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1053 1.1 skrll if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1054 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1055 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1056 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1057 1.3 christos if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1058 1.3 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1059 1.1 skrll
1060 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1061 1.1 skrll {
1062 1.1 skrll /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1063 1.1 skrll not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1064 1.1 skrll if (name [0] == '.')
1065 1.1 skrll {
1066 1.5 christos const char *p;
1067 1.5 christos int n;
1068 1.5 christos if (name[1] == 'd')
1069 1.5 christos p = ".debug", n = 6;
1070 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1071 1.5 christos p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1072 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1073 1.5 christos p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1074 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'l')
1075 1.5 christos p = ".line", n = 5;
1076 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 's')
1077 1.5 christos p = ".stab", n = 5;
1078 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'z')
1079 1.5 christos p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1080 1.5 christos else
1081 1.5 christos p = NULL, n = 0;
1082 1.5 christos if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1083 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1084 1.1 skrll }
1085 1.1 skrll }
1086 1.1 skrll
1087 1.1 skrll /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1088 1.1 skrll only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1089 1.1 skrll g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1090 1.1 skrll The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1091 1.1 skrll are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1092 1.1 skrll all but one of the sections. */
1093 1.1 skrll if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1094 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1095 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1096 1.1 skrll
1097 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1098 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1099 1.1 skrll if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1100 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1101 1.1 skrll
1102 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1103 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1104 1.1 skrll
1105 1.1 skrll /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1106 1.1 skrll separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1107 1.1 skrll PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1108 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1109 1.1 skrll {
1110 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents;
1111 1.1 skrll
1112 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1113 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1114 1.1 skrll
1115 1.9 christos elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1116 1.9 christos hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1117 1.1 skrll free (contents);
1118 1.1 skrll }
1119 1.1 skrll
1120 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1121 1.1 skrll {
1122 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1123 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, nload;
1124 1.1 skrll
1125 1.1 skrll /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1126 1.1 skrll p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1127 1.1 skrll one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1128 1.1 skrll so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1129 1.1 skrll phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1130 1.1 skrll for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1131 1.1 skrll if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1132 1.1 skrll break;
1133 1.1 skrll else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1134 1.1 skrll ++nload;
1135 1.1 skrll if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1136 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1137 1.1 skrll
1138 1.1 skrll phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1139 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1140 1.1 skrll {
1141 1.3 christos if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1142 1.3 christos && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1143 1.3 christos || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1144 1.3 christos && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1145 1.1 skrll {
1146 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1147 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1148 1.1 skrll + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1149 1.1 skrll else
1150 1.1 skrll /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1151 1.1 skrll sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1152 1.1 skrll is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1153 1.1 skrll Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1154 1.1 skrll the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1155 1.1 skrll segment will contain sections with contiguous
1156 1.1 skrll LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1157 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1158 1.1 skrll + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1159 1.1 skrll
1160 1.1 skrll /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1161 1.1 skrll offsets whether a section with zero size should
1162 1.1 skrll be placed at the end of one segment or the
1163 1.1 skrll beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1164 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1165 1.1 skrll && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1166 1.1 skrll <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1167 1.1 skrll break;
1168 1.1 skrll }
1169 1.1 skrll }
1170 1.1 skrll }
1171 1.1 skrll
1172 1.3 christos /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1173 1.3 christos .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1174 1.3 christos if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1175 1.3 christos && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1176 1.3 christos || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1177 1.3 christos {
1178 1.3 christos enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1179 1.6 christos int compression_header_size;
1180 1.6 christos bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1181 1.6 christos bfd_boolean compressed
1182 1.6 christos = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1183 1.6 christos &compression_header_size,
1184 1.6 christos &uncompressed_size);
1185 1.3 christos
1186 1.6 christos if (compressed)
1187 1.3 christos {
1188 1.3 christos /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1189 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1190 1.3 christos action = decompress;
1191 1.3 christos }
1192 1.6 christos
1193 1.6 christos /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1194 1.6 christos section. Check if we should compress. */
1195 1.6 christos if (action == nothing)
1196 1.6 christos {
1197 1.6 christos if (newsect->size != 0
1198 1.6 christos && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1199 1.6 christos && compression_header_size >= 0
1200 1.6 christos && uncompressed_size > 0
1201 1.6 christos && (!compressed
1202 1.6 christos || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1203 1.6 christos != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1204 1.3 christos action = compress;
1205 1.6 christos else
1206 1.6 christos return TRUE;
1207 1.3 christos }
1208 1.1 skrll
1209 1.6 christos if (action == compress)
1210 1.3 christos {
1211 1.3 christos if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1212 1.3 christos {
1213 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
1214 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1215 1.13 christos (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1216 1.3 christos abfd, name);
1217 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1218 1.3 christos }
1219 1.6 christos }
1220 1.6 christos else
1221 1.6 christos {
1222 1.3 christos if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1223 1.3 christos {
1224 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
1225 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1226 1.13 christos (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1227 1.3 christos abfd, name);
1228 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1229 1.3 christos }
1230 1.6 christos }
1231 1.1 skrll
1232 1.6 christos if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1233 1.6 christos {
1234 1.6 christos if (name[1] == 'z'
1235 1.6 christos && (action == decompress
1236 1.6 christos || (action == compress
1237 1.6 christos && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1238 1.6 christos {
1239 1.6 christos /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1240 1.6 christos that linker will consider this section as a debug
1241 1.6 christos section. */
1242 1.6 christos char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1243 1.3 christos if (new_name == NULL)
1244 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1245 1.6 christos bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1246 1.3 christos }
1247 1.1 skrll }
1248 1.6 christos else
1249 1.6 christos /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1250 1.6 christos section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1251 1.6 christos newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1252 1.1 skrll }
1253 1.3 christos
1254 1.3 christos return TRUE;
1255 1.1 skrll }
1256 1.1 skrll
1257 1.7 christos const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1258 1.7 christos {
1259 1.1 skrll "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1260 1.1 skrll "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1261 1.1 skrll "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1262 1.1 skrll };
1263 1.1 skrll
1264 1.1 skrll /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1265 1.1 skrll output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1266 1.1 skrll has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1267 1.1 skrll be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1268 1.1 skrll change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1269 1.1 skrll all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1270 1.1 skrll into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1271 1.1 skrll function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1272 1.1 skrll relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1273 1.1 skrll
1274 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
1275 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1276 1.1 skrll arelent *reloc_entry,
1277 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
1278 1.1 skrll void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1279 1.1 skrll asection *input_section,
1280 1.1 skrll bfd *output_bfd,
1281 1.1 skrll char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1282 1.1 skrll {
1283 1.1 skrll if (output_bfd != NULL
1284 1.1 skrll && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1285 1.1 skrll && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1286 1.1 skrll || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1287 1.1 skrll {
1288 1.1 skrll reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1289 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_ok;
1290 1.1 skrll }
1291 1.1 skrll
1292 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_continue;
1293 1.1 skrll }
1294 1.1 skrll
1295 1.7 christos /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1297 1.7 christos Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1298 1.7 christos should be the same. */
1299 1.7 christos
1300 1.7 christos static bfd_boolean
1301 1.7 christos section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1302 1.7 christos const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1303 1.7 christos {
1304 1.9 christos return
1305 1.7 christos a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1306 1.7 christos && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1307 1.7 christos == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1308 1.7 christos && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1309 1.7 christos && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1310 1.7 christos && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1311 1.7 christos /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1312 1.7 christos ;
1313 1.7 christos }
1314 1.7 christos
1315 1.7 christos /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1316 1.7 christos as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1317 1.7 christos none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1318 1.7 christos to be the correct section. */
1319 1.7 christos
1320 1.9 christos static unsigned int
1321 1.9 christos find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1322 1.7 christos const unsigned int hint)
1323 1.7 christos {
1324 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1325 1.7 christos unsigned int i;
1326 1.9 christos
1327 1.9 christos BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1328 1.9 christos
1329 1.9 christos /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1330 1.9 christos if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1331 1.9 christos && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1332 1.7 christos && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1333 1.7 christos return hint;
1334 1.7 christos
1335 1.7 christos for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1336 1.7 christos {
1337 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1338 1.9 christos
1339 1.9 christos if (oheader == NULL)
1340 1.7 christos continue;
1341 1.7 christos if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1342 1.7 christos /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1343 1.7 christos multiple matches ? */
1344 1.7 christos return i;
1345 1.7 christos }
1346 1.7 christos
1347 1.7 christos return SHN_UNDEF;
1348 1.7 christos }
1349 1.7 christos
1350 1.7 christos /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1351 1.7 christos Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1352 1.9 christos Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1353 1.7 christos
1354 1.7 christos static bfd_boolean
1355 1.7 christos copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1356 1.7 christos bfd *obfd,
1357 1.7 christos const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1358 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1359 1.7 christos const unsigned int secnum)
1360 1.7 christos {
1361 1.7 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1362 1.7 christos const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1363 1.7 christos bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1364 1.7 christos unsigned int sh_link;
1365 1.7 christos
1366 1.7 christos if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1367 1.7 christos {
1368 1.7 christos /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1369 1.7 christos When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1370 1.7 christos the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1371 1.7 christos matched up with the original.
1372 1.7 christos
1373 1.7 christos Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1374 1.7 christos The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1375 1.7 christos relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1376 1.7 christos the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1377 1.7 christos the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1378 1.7 christos original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1379 1.7 christos that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1380 1.7 christos the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1381 1.7 christos creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1382 1.7 christos that just contains debug info and only for sections
1383 1.7 christos without any contents. */
1384 1.7 christos if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1385 1.7 christos oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1386 1.7 christos if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1387 1.7 christos oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1388 1.7 christos return TRUE;
1389 1.7 christos }
1390 1.7 christos
1391 1.7 christos /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1392 1.7 christos if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1393 1.7 christos && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1394 1.7 christos (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1395 1.7 christos return TRUE;
1396 1.7 christos
1397 1.7 christos /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1398 1.7 christos sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1399 1.7 christos the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1400 1.7 christos in the input bfd. */
1401 1.7 christos if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1402 1.9 christos {
1403 1.9 christos /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1404 1.9 christos if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1405 1.9 christos {
1406 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
1407 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1408 1.9 christos (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1409 1.9 christos ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1410 1.9 christos return FALSE;
1411 1.9 christos }
1412 1.7 christos
1413 1.7 christos sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1414 1.7 christos if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1415 1.7 christos {
1416 1.7 christos oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1417 1.7 christos changed = TRUE;
1418 1.7 christos }
1419 1.7 christos else
1420 1.7 christos /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1421 1.9 christos if we could not find a match ? */
1422 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
1423 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1424 1.7 christos (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1425 1.7 christos }
1426 1.7 christos
1427 1.7 christos if (iheader->sh_info)
1428 1.7 christos {
1429 1.7 christos /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1430 1.7 christos SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1431 1.7 christos section index. */
1432 1.7 christos if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1433 1.7 christos {
1434 1.7 christos sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1435 1.7 christos iheader->sh_info);
1436 1.7 christos if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1437 1.7 christos oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1438 1.7 christos }
1439 1.7 christos else
1440 1.7 christos /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1441 1.7 christos sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1442 1.7 christos
1443 1.7 christos if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1444 1.7 christos {
1445 1.7 christos oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1446 1.7 christos changed = TRUE;
1447 1.7 christos }
1448 1.9 christos else
1449 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
1450 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1451 1.7 christos (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1452 1.7 christos }
1453 1.7 christos
1454 1.7 christos return changed;
1455 1.9 christos }
1456 1.1 skrll
1457 1.1 skrll /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1458 1.1 skrll another. */
1459 1.1 skrll
1460 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1461 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1462 1.7 christos {
1463 1.7 christos const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1464 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1465 1.7 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1466 1.7 christos unsigned int i;
1467 1.1 skrll
1468 1.7 christos if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1469 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1470 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1471 1.6 christos
1472 1.6 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1473 1.6 christos {
1474 1.6 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1475 1.6 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1476 1.1 skrll }
1477 1.1 skrll
1478 1.6 christos elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1479 1.6 christos
1480 1.6 christos /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1481 1.6 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1482 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1483 1.7 christos
1484 1.7 christos /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1485 1.7 christos if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1486 1.7 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1487 1.9 christos = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1488 1.1 skrll
1489 1.1 skrll /* Copy object attributes. */
1490 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1491 1.7 christos
1492 1.7 christos if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1493 1.7 christos return TRUE;
1494 1.7 christos
1495 1.6 christos bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1496 1.7 christos
1497 1.7 christos /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1498 1.6 christos for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1499 1.7 christos {
1500 1.7 christos unsigned int j;
1501 1.7 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1502 1.7 christos
1503 1.7 christos /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1504 1.7 christos because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1505 1.7 christos files. See below for more details. */
1506 1.7 christos if (oheader == NULL
1507 1.7 christos || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1508 1.7 christos && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1509 1.7 christos continue;
1510 1.7 christos
1511 1.7 christos /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1512 1.7 christos fields have already been initialised. */
1513 1.7 christos if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1514 1.7 christos || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1515 1.7 christos continue;
1516 1.7 christos
1517 1.7 christos /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1518 1.7 christos First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1519 1.7 christos for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1520 1.7 christos {
1521 1.7 christos const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1522 1.7 christos
1523 1.7 christos if (iheader == NULL)
1524 1.7 christos continue;
1525 1.7 christos
1526 1.7 christos if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1527 1.7 christos && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1528 1.7 christos && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1529 1.7 christos && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1530 1.7 christos {
1531 1.7 christos /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1532 1.7 christos output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1533 1.7 christos this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1534 1.7 christos should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1535 1.7 christos if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1536 1.7 christos j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1537 1.7 christos break;
1538 1.7 christos }
1539 1.7 christos }
1540 1.7 christos
1541 1.7 christos if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1542 1.6 christos continue;
1543 1.7 christos
1544 1.7 christos /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1545 1.7 christos Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1546 1.7 christos is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1547 1.6 christos for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1548 1.7 christos {
1549 1.6 christos const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1550 1.7 christos
1551 1.6 christos if (iheader == NULL)
1552 1.6 christos continue;
1553 1.7 christos
1554 1.7 christos /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1555 1.7 christos Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1556 1.7 christos SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1557 1.7 christos input type. */
1558 1.7 christos if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1559 1.7 christos || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1560 1.7 christos && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1561 1.7 christos == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1562 1.7 christos && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1563 1.7 christos && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1564 1.7 christos && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1565 1.7 christos && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1566 1.7 christos && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1567 1.7 christos || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1568 1.7 christos {
1569 1.7 christos if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1570 1.6 christos break;
1571 1.6 christos }
1572 1.7 christos }
1573 1.7 christos
1574 1.7 christos if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1575 1.7 christos {
1576 1.7 christos /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1577 1.7 christos with a NULL input section. */
1578 1.7 christos if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1579 1.7 christos bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1580 1.6 christos }
1581 1.6 christos }
1582 1.1 skrll
1583 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1584 1.1 skrll }
1585 1.1 skrll
1586 1.1 skrll static const char *
1587 1.1 skrll get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1588 1.1 skrll {
1589 1.1 skrll const char *pt;
1590 1.1 skrll switch (p_type)
1591 1.1 skrll {
1592 1.1 skrll case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1593 1.1 skrll case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1594 1.1 skrll case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1595 1.1 skrll case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1596 1.1 skrll case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1597 1.1 skrll case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1598 1.1 skrll case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1599 1.1 skrll case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1600 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1601 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1602 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1603 1.1 skrll default: pt = NULL; break;
1604 1.1 skrll }
1605 1.1 skrll return pt;
1606 1.1 skrll }
1607 1.1 skrll
1608 1.1 skrll /* Print out the program headers. */
1609 1.1 skrll
1610 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1611 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1612 1.3 christos {
1613 1.1 skrll FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1614 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1615 1.1 skrll asection *s;
1616 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1617 1.1 skrll
1618 1.1 skrll p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1619 1.1 skrll if (p != NULL)
1620 1.1 skrll {
1621 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, c;
1622 1.1 skrll
1623 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1624 1.1 skrll c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1625 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1626 1.1 skrll {
1627 1.1 skrll const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1628 1.1 skrll char buf[20];
1629 1.1 skrll
1630 1.1 skrll if (pt == NULL)
1631 1.1 skrll {
1632 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1633 1.1 skrll pt = buf;
1634 1.1 skrll }
1635 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1636 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1637 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1638 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1639 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1640 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1641 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1642 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1643 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1644 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1645 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1646 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1647 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1648 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1649 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1650 1.1 skrll if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1651 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1652 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1653 1.1 skrll }
1654 1.1 skrll }
1655 1.1 skrll
1656 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1657 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
1658 1.1 skrll {
1659 1.1 skrll unsigned int elfsec;
1660 1.1 skrll unsigned long shlink;
1661 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1662 1.1 skrll size_t extdynsize;
1663 1.1 skrll void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1664 1.1 skrll
1665 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1666 1.1 skrll
1667 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1668 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1669 1.1 skrll
1670 1.1 skrll elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1671 1.1 skrll if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1672 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1673 1.1 skrll shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1674 1.1 skrll
1675 1.1 skrll extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1676 1.1 skrll swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1677 1.1 skrll
1678 1.6 christos extdyn = dynbuf;
1679 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1680 1.6 christos if (s->size < extdynsize)
1681 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1682 1.6 christos extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1683 1.9 christos /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1684 1.6 christos Fix range check. */
1685 1.1 skrll for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1686 1.1 skrll {
1687 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1688 1.1 skrll const char *name = "";
1689 1.1 skrll char ab[20];
1690 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean stringp;
1691 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1692 1.1 skrll
1693 1.1 skrll (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1694 1.1 skrll
1695 1.1 skrll if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1696 1.1 skrll break;
1697 1.1 skrll
1698 1.1 skrll stringp = FALSE;
1699 1.1 skrll switch (dyn.d_tag)
1700 1.1 skrll {
1701 1.1 skrll default:
1702 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1703 1.1 skrll name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1704 1.1 skrll
1705 1.1 skrll if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1706 1.9 christos {
1707 1.1 skrll sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1708 1.1 skrll name = ab;
1709 1.1 skrll }
1710 1.1 skrll break;
1711 1.1 skrll
1712 1.1 skrll case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1713 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1714 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1715 1.1 skrll case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1716 1.1 skrll case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1717 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1718 1.1 skrll case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1719 1.1 skrll case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1720 1.1 skrll case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1721 1.1 skrll case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1722 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1723 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1724 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1725 1.1 skrll case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1726 1.1 skrll case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1727 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1728 1.1 skrll case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1729 1.1 skrll case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1730 1.1 skrll case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1731 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1732 1.1 skrll case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1733 1.1 skrll case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1734 1.1 skrll case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1735 1.1 skrll case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1736 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1737 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1738 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1739 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1740 1.1 skrll case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1741 1.1 skrll case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1742 1.1 skrll case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1743 1.1 skrll case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1744 1.1 skrll case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1745 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1746 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1747 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1748 1.1 skrll case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1749 1.1 skrll case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1750 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1751 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1752 1.1 skrll case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1753 1.1 skrll case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1754 1.1 skrll case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1755 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1756 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1757 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1758 1.1 skrll case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1759 1.1 skrll case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1760 1.1 skrll case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1761 1.1 skrll case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1762 1.1 skrll case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1763 1.1 skrll case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1764 1.1 skrll case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1765 1.1 skrll case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1766 1.1 skrll case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1767 1.1 skrll case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1768 1.1 skrll case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1769 1.1 skrll case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1770 1.1 skrll }
1771 1.1 skrll
1772 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1773 1.1 skrll if (! stringp)
1774 1.1 skrll {
1775 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "0x");
1776 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1777 1.1 skrll }
1778 1.1 skrll else
1779 1.1 skrll {
1780 1.1 skrll const char *string;
1781 1.1 skrll unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1782 1.1 skrll
1783 1.1 skrll string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1784 1.1 skrll if (string == NULL)
1785 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1786 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1787 1.1 skrll }
1788 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1789 1.1 skrll }
1790 1.1 skrll
1791 1.1 skrll free (dynbuf);
1792 1.1 skrll dynbuf = NULL;
1793 1.1 skrll }
1794 1.1 skrll
1795 1.1 skrll if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1796 1.1 skrll || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1797 1.1 skrll {
1798 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1799 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1800 1.1 skrll }
1801 1.1 skrll
1802 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1803 1.1 skrll {
1804 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1805 1.1 skrll
1806 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1807 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1808 1.1 skrll {
1809 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1810 1.1 skrll t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1811 1.1 skrll t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1812 1.1 skrll if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1813 1.1 skrll {
1814 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1815 1.1 skrll
1816 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\t");
1817 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1818 1.1 skrll a != NULL;
1819 1.1 skrll a = a->vda_nextptr)
1820 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%s ",
1821 1.1 skrll a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1822 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1823 1.1 skrll }
1824 1.1 skrll }
1825 1.1 skrll }
1826 1.1 skrll
1827 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1828 1.1 skrll {
1829 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1830 1.1 skrll
1831 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1832 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1833 1.1 skrll {
1834 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1835 1.1 skrll
1836 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1837 1.1 skrll t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1838 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1839 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1840 1.1 skrll a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1841 1.1 skrll a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1842 1.1 skrll }
1843 1.1 skrll }
1844 1.1 skrll
1845 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1846 1.1 skrll
1847 1.1 skrll error_return:
1848 1.1 skrll if (dynbuf != NULL)
1849 1.1 skrll free (dynbuf);
1850 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1851 1.1 skrll }
1852 1.6 christos
1853 1.6 christos /* Get version string. */
1854 1.6 christos
1855 1.6 christos const char *
1856 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1857 1.6 christos bfd_boolean *hidden)
1858 1.6 christos {
1859 1.6 christos const char *version_string = NULL;
1860 1.6 christos if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1861 1.6 christos && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1862 1.6 christos {
1863 1.6 christos unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1864 1.6 christos
1865 1.6 christos *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1866 1.6 christos vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1867 1.6 christos
1868 1.6 christos if (vernum == 0)
1869 1.13 christos version_string = "";
1870 1.13 christos else if (vernum == 1
1871 1.13 christos && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1872 1.13 christos || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1873 1.6 christos == VER_FLG_BASE)))
1874 1.6 christos version_string = "Base";
1875 1.6 christos else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1876 1.6 christos version_string =
1877 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1878 1.6 christos else
1879 1.6 christos {
1880 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1881 1.6 christos
1882 1.6 christos version_string = "";
1883 1.6 christos for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1884 1.6 christos t != NULL;
1885 1.6 christos t = t->vn_nextref)
1886 1.6 christos {
1887 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1888 1.6 christos
1889 1.6 christos for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1890 1.6 christos {
1891 1.6 christos if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1892 1.6 christos {
1893 1.6 christos version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1894 1.6 christos break;
1895 1.6 christos }
1896 1.6 christos }
1897 1.6 christos }
1898 1.6 christos }
1899 1.6 christos }
1900 1.6 christos return version_string;
1901 1.6 christos }
1902 1.1 skrll
1903 1.1 skrll /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1904 1.1 skrll
1905 1.1 skrll void
1906 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1907 1.1 skrll void *filep,
1908 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
1909 1.1 skrll bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1910 1.3 christos {
1911 1.1 skrll FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1912 1.1 skrll switch (how)
1913 1.1 skrll {
1914 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1915 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1916 1.1 skrll break;
1917 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1918 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, "elf ");
1919 1.9 christos bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1920 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1921 1.1 skrll break;
1922 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1923 1.1 skrll {
1924 1.1 skrll const char *section_name;
1925 1.1 skrll const char *name = NULL;
1926 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1927 1.1 skrll unsigned char st_other;
1928 1.6 christos bfd_vma val;
1929 1.6 christos const char *version_string;
1930 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean hidden;
1931 1.1 skrll
1932 1.1 skrll section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1933 1.1 skrll
1934 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1935 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1936 1.1 skrll name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1937 1.1 skrll
1938 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
1939 1.1 skrll {
1940 1.1 skrll name = symbol->name;
1941 1.1 skrll bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1942 1.1 skrll }
1943 1.1 skrll
1944 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1945 1.1 skrll /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1946 1.1 skrll we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1947 1.1 skrll For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1948 1.1 skrll we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1949 1.1 skrll if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1950 1.1 skrll val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1951 1.1 skrll else
1952 1.1 skrll val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1953 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1954 1.1 skrll
1955 1.6 christos /* If we have version information, print it. */
1956 1.6 christos version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1957 1.6 christos symbol,
1958 1.6 christos &hidden);
1959 1.1 skrll if (version_string)
1960 1.6 christos {
1961 1.1 skrll if (!hidden)
1962 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1963 1.1 skrll else
1964 1.1 skrll {
1965 1.1 skrll int i;
1966 1.1 skrll
1967 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1968 1.1 skrll for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1969 1.1 skrll putc (' ', file);
1970 1.1 skrll }
1971 1.1 skrll }
1972 1.1 skrll
1973 1.1 skrll /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1974 1.1 skrll st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1975 1.1 skrll
1976 1.1 skrll switch (st_other)
1977 1.1 skrll {
1978 1.1 skrll case 0: break;
1979 1.1 skrll case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1980 1.1 skrll case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1981 1.1 skrll case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1982 1.1 skrll default:
1983 1.1 skrll /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1984 1.1 skrll everything hex. */
1985 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1986 1.1 skrll }
1987 1.1 skrll
1988 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1989 1.1 skrll }
1990 1.1 skrll break;
1991 1.1 skrll }
1992 1.1 skrll }
1993 1.1 skrll
1994 1.1 skrll /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1996 1.1 skrll
1997 1.1 skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1998 1.1 skrll
1999 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2000 1.1 skrll bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
2001 1.1 skrll {
2002 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2003 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2004 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2005 1.6 christos const char *name;
2006 1.6 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
2007 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
2008 1.1 skrll static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2009 1.1 skrll static unsigned int nesting = 0;
2010 1.1 skrll
2011 1.1 skrll if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2012 1.6 christos return FALSE;
2013 1.6 christos
2014 1.6 christos if (++ nesting > 3)
2015 1.6 christos {
2016 1.6 christos /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2017 1.6 christos sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
2018 1.6 christos loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2019 1.6 christos already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2020 1.6 christos we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2021 1.6 christos can expect to recurse at least once.
2022 1.6 christos
2023 1.6 christos FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2024 1.6 christos rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2025 1.6 christos
2026 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2027 1.6 christos sections_being_created = NULL;
2028 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2029 1.6 christos {
2030 1.6 christos /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2031 1.6 christos sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2032 1.6 christos bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2033 1.6 christos sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2034 1.6 christos }
2035 1.9 christos if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2036 1.13 christos {
2037 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler
2038 1.6 christos (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2039 1.6 christos return FALSE;
2040 1.6 christos }
2041 1.6 christos sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2042 1.1 skrll }
2043 1.1 skrll
2044 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2045 1.1 skrll ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2046 1.1 skrll name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2047 1.6 christos hdr->sh_name);
2048 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
2049 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2050 1.1 skrll
2051 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2052 1.1 skrll switch (hdr->sh_type)
2053 1.1 skrll {
2054 1.6 christos case SHT_NULL:
2055 1.1 skrll /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2056 1.6 christos goto success;
2057 1.6 christos
2058 1.6 christos case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2059 1.6 christos case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2060 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2061 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2062 1.1 skrll case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2063 1.1 skrll case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2064 1.1 skrll case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2065 1.6 christos case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2066 1.6 christos case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2067 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2068 1.1 skrll goto success;
2069 1.1 skrll
2070 1.6 christos case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2071 1.6 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2072 1.3 christos goto fail;
2073 1.3 christos
2074 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2075 1.3 christos {
2076 1.3 christos /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2077 1.3 christos field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2078 1.3 christos switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2079 1.3 christos {
2080 1.3 christos case bfd_arch_i386:
2081 1.3 christos case bfd_arch_sparc:
2082 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2083 1.3 christos || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2084 1.3 christos break;
2085 1.6 christos /* Otherwise fall through. */
2086 1.3 christos default:
2087 1.3 christos goto fail;
2088 1.3 christos }
2089 1.6 christos }
2090 1.3 christos else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2091 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2092 1.1 skrll else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2093 1.1 skrll {
2094 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2095 1.1 skrll
2096 1.1 skrll /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2097 1.1 skrll sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2098 1.1 skrll string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2099 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2100 1.1 skrll {
2101 1.1 skrll dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2102 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2103 1.1 skrll }
2104 1.1 skrll else
2105 1.1 skrll {
2106 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
2107 1.1 skrll
2108 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2109 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2110 1.1 skrll {
2111 1.1 skrll dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2112 1.1 skrll if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2113 1.1 skrll {
2114 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2115 1.1 skrll break;
2116 1.1 skrll }
2117 1.1 skrll }
2118 1.6 christos }
2119 1.1 skrll }
2120 1.6 christos goto success;
2121 1.1 skrll
2122 1.6 christos case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2123 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2124 1.1 skrll goto success;
2125 1.6 christos
2126 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2127 1.2 skrll goto fail;
2128 1.5 christos
2129 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2130 1.6 christos {
2131 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2132 1.5 christos goto fail;
2133 1.5 christos /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2134 1.5 christos zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2135 1.6 christos of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2136 1.6 christos hdr->sh_info = 0;
2137 1.6 christos goto success;
2138 1.6 christos }
2139 1.6 christos
2140 1.6 christos /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2141 1.6 christos Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2142 1.9 christos if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2143 1.9 christos {
2144 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2145 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2146 1.6 christos (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2147 1.6 christos " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2148 1.5 christos abfd, shindex);
2149 1.1 skrll goto success;
2150 1.6 christos }
2151 1.6 christos elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2152 1.1 skrll elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2153 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2154 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2155 1.1 skrll
2156 1.1 skrll /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2157 1.1 skrll SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2158 1.1 skrll treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2159 1.1 skrll decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2160 1.1 skrll set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2161 1.1 skrll linker. */
2162 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2163 1.1 skrll && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2164 1.6 christos && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2165 1.1 skrll shindex))
2166 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2167 1.1 skrll
2168 1.1 skrll /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2169 1.6 christos can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2170 1.6 christos is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2171 1.6 christos {
2172 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
2173 1.6 christos unsigned int i, num_sec;
2174 1.6 christos
2175 1.6 christos for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2176 1.6 christos if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2177 1.6 christos goto success;
2178 1.6 christos
2179 1.6 christos num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2180 1.6 christos for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2181 1.6 christos {
2182 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2183 1.6 christos
2184 1.6 christos if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2185 1.6 christos && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2186 1.1 skrll break;
2187 1.6 christos }
2188 1.6 christos
2189 1.1 skrll if (i == num_sec)
2190 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2191 1.6 christos {
2192 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2193 1.1 skrll
2194 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2195 1.1 skrll && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2196 1.1 skrll break;
2197 1.6 christos }
2198 1.6 christos
2199 1.6 christos if (i != shindex)
2200 1.6 christos ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2201 1.6 christos /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2202 1.6 christos goto success;
2203 1.6 christos }
2204 1.1 skrll
2205 1.6 christos case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2206 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2207 1.1 skrll goto success;
2208 1.6 christos
2209 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2210 1.5 christos goto fail;
2211 1.5 christos
2212 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2213 1.6 christos {
2214 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2215 1.5 christos goto fail;
2216 1.5 christos
2217 1.5 christos /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2218 1.5 christos zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2219 1.6 christos of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2220 1.6 christos hdr->sh_info = 0;
2221 1.6 christos goto success;
2222 1.6 christos }
2223 1.6 christos
2224 1.6 christos /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2225 1.6 christos Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2226 1.9 christos if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2227 1.9 christos {
2228 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2229 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2230 1.6 christos (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2231 1.6 christos " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2232 1.5 christos abfd, shindex);
2233 1.1 skrll goto success;
2234 1.1 skrll }
2235 1.1 skrll elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2236 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2237 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2238 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2239 1.1 skrll
2240 1.6 christos /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2241 1.6 christos section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2242 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2243 1.6 christos goto success;
2244 1.6 christos
2245 1.6 christos case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2246 1.1 skrll {
2247 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
2248 1.6 christos
2249 1.6 christos for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2250 1.9 christos if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2251 1.6 christos goto success;
2252 1.6 christos
2253 1.6 christos entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2254 1.6 christos if (entry == NULL)
2255 1.6 christos goto fail;
2256 1.6 christos entry->ndx = shindex;
2257 1.6 christos entry->hdr = * hdr;
2258 1.6 christos entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2259 1.6 christos elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2260 1.6 christos elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2261 1.1 skrll goto success;
2262 1.6 christos }
2263 1.1 skrll
2264 1.6 christos case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2265 1.6 christos if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2266 1.1 skrll goto success;
2267 1.1 skrll
2268 1.1 skrll if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2269 1.1 skrll {
2270 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2271 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2272 1.6 christos goto success;
2273 1.1 skrll }
2274 1.1 skrll
2275 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2276 1.1 skrll {
2277 1.1 skrll symtab_strtab:
2278 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2279 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2280 1.6 christos goto success;
2281 1.1 skrll }
2282 1.1 skrll
2283 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2284 1.1 skrll {
2285 1.1 skrll dynsymtab_strtab:
2286 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2287 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2288 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2289 1.6 christos /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2290 1.6 christos can handle it. */
2291 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2292 1.1 skrll shindex);
2293 1.1 skrll goto success;
2294 1.1 skrll }
2295 1.1 skrll
2296 1.1 skrll /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2297 1.1 skrll regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2298 1.1 skrll just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2299 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2300 1.1 skrll {
2301 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
2302 1.1 skrll
2303 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2304 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2305 1.1 skrll {
2306 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2307 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2308 1.1 skrll {
2309 1.6 christos /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2310 1.1 skrll if (i == shindex)
2311 1.6 christos goto fail;
2312 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2313 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2314 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2315 1.1 skrll goto symtab_strtab;
2316 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2317 1.1 skrll goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2318 1.1 skrll }
2319 1.6 christos }
2320 1.6 christos }
2321 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2322 1.1 skrll goto success;
2323 1.1 skrll
2324 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
2325 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
2326 1.1 skrll /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2327 1.3 christos {
2328 1.1 skrll asection *target_sect;
2329 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2330 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2331 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2332 1.1 skrll
2333 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_entsize
2334 1.6 christos != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2335 1.1 skrll ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2336 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2337 1.1 skrll
2338 1.1 skrll /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2339 1.9 christos if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2340 1.9 christos {
2341 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2342 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2343 1.6 christos (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2344 1.6 christos abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2345 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2346 1.1 skrll shindex);
2347 1.1 skrll goto success;
2348 1.1 skrll }
2349 1.1 skrll
2350 1.1 skrll /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2351 1.1 skrll libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2352 1.1 skrll bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2353 1.1 skrll reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2354 1.3 christos them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2355 1.3 christos one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2356 1.3 christos to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2357 1.3 christos
2358 1.3 christos Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2359 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2360 1.1 skrll && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2361 1.1 skrll && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2362 1.1 skrll {
2363 1.1 skrll unsigned int scan;
2364 1.1 skrll int found;
2365 1.1 skrll
2366 1.1 skrll found = 0;
2367 1.1 skrll for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2368 1.1 skrll {
2369 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2370 1.1 skrll || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2371 1.1 skrll {
2372 1.1 skrll if (found != 0)
2373 1.1 skrll {
2374 1.1 skrll found = 0;
2375 1.1 skrll break;
2376 1.1 skrll }
2377 1.1 skrll found = scan;
2378 1.1 skrll }
2379 1.1 skrll }
2380 1.1 skrll if (found != 0)
2381 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = found;
2382 1.1 skrll }
2383 1.1 skrll
2384 1.1 skrll /* Get the symbol table. */
2385 1.1 skrll if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2386 1.6 christos || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2387 1.1 skrll && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2388 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2389 1.1 skrll
2390 1.1 skrll /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2391 1.1 skrll don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2392 1.1 skrll represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2393 1.3 christos try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2394 1.3 christos can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2395 1.1 skrll section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2396 1.3 christos sh_link points to the null section. */
2397 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2398 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2399 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2400 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2401 1.6 christos || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2402 1.6 christos || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2403 1.6 christos {
2404 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2405 1.6 christos shindex);
2406 1.1 skrll goto success;
2407 1.1 skrll }
2408 1.6 christos
2409 1.6 christos if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2410 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2411 1.1 skrll
2412 1.6 christos target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2413 1.1 skrll if (target_sect == NULL)
2414 1.3 christos goto fail;
2415 1.3 christos
2416 1.3 christos esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2417 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2418 1.3 christos p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2419 1.3 christos else
2420 1.6 christos p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2421 1.6 christos
2422 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2423 1.7 christos if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2424 1.3 christos goto fail;
2425 1.6 christos hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2426 1.1 skrll if (hdr2 == NULL)
2427 1.3 christos goto fail;
2428 1.1 skrll *hdr2 = *hdr;
2429 1.9 christos *p_hdr = hdr2;
2430 1.9 christos elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2431 1.1 skrll target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2432 1.1 skrll * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2433 1.1 skrll target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2434 1.1 skrll target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2435 1.1 skrll target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2436 1.1 skrll /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2437 1.3 christos its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2438 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2439 1.3 christos {
2440 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2441 1.1 skrll target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2442 1.6 christos }
2443 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2444 1.1 skrll goto success;
2445 1.1 skrll }
2446 1.1 skrll
2447 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2448 1.6 christos elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2449 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2450 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2451 1.1 skrll goto success;
2452 1.1 skrll
2453 1.6 christos case SHT_GNU_versym:
2454 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2455 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2456 1.1 skrll
2457 1.6 christos elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2458 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2459 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2460 1.1 skrll goto success;
2461 1.1 skrll
2462 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2463 1.6 christos elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2464 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2465 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2466 1.1 skrll goto success;
2467 1.6 christos
2468 1.1 skrll case SHT_SHLIB:
2469 1.1 skrll goto success;
2470 1.6 christos
2471 1.6 christos case SHT_GROUP:
2472 1.6 christos if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2473 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2474 1.6 christos
2475 1.6 christos if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2476 1.6 christos goto fail;
2477 1.1 skrll
2478 1.1 skrll goto success;
2479 1.1 skrll
2480 1.1 skrll default:
2481 1.1 skrll /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2482 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2483 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2484 1.6 christos {
2485 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2486 1.6 christos goto fail;
2487 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2488 1.1 skrll goto success;
2489 1.1 skrll }
2490 1.1 skrll
2491 1.6 christos /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2492 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2493 1.1 skrll goto success;
2494 1.1 skrll
2495 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2496 1.1 skrll {
2497 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2498 1.9 christos /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2499 1.9 christos for applications? */
2500 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2501 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2502 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2503 1.6 christos abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2504 1.6 christos else
2505 1.6 christos {
2506 1.6 christos /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2507 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2508 1.6 christos shindex);
2509 1.1 skrll goto success;
2510 1.1 skrll }
2511 1.1 skrll }
2512 1.1 skrll else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2513 1.9 christos && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2514 1.9 christos /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2515 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2516 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2517 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2518 1.1 skrll abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2519 1.1 skrll else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2520 1.1 skrll {
2521 1.1 skrll /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2522 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2523 1.1 skrll /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2524 1.9 christos required to correctly process the section and the file should
2525 1.9 christos be rejected with an error message. */
2526 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2527 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2528 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2529 1.6 christos abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2530 1.6 christos else
2531 1.6 christos {
2532 1.6 christos /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2533 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2534 1.1 skrll goto success;
2535 1.1 skrll }
2536 1.1 skrll }
2537 1.9 christos else
2538 1.9 christos /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2539 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
2540 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2541 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2542 1.6 christos abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2543 1.1 skrll
2544 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2545 1.6 christos }
2546 1.6 christos
2547 1.6 christos fail:
2548 1.6 christos ret = FALSE;
2549 1.6 christos success:
2550 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2551 1.6 christos sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2552 1.6 christos if (-- nesting == 0)
2553 1.6 christos {
2554 1.6 christos sections_being_created = NULL;
2555 1.6 christos sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2556 1.1 skrll }
2557 1.1 skrll return ret;
2558 1.3 christos }
2559 1.1 skrll
2560 1.3 christos /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2561 1.3 christos
2562 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *
2563 1.3 christos bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2564 1.1 skrll bfd *abfd,
2565 1.1 skrll unsigned long r_symndx)
2566 1.1 skrll {
2567 1.1 skrll unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2568 1.1 skrll
2569 1.1 skrll if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2570 1.1 skrll {
2571 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2572 1.1 skrll unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2573 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2574 1.1 skrll
2575 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2576 1.1 skrll if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2577 1.1 skrll &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2578 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2579 1.1 skrll
2580 1.1 skrll if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2581 1.1 skrll {
2582 1.1 skrll memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2583 1.1 skrll cache->abfd = abfd;
2584 1.1 skrll }
2585 1.1 skrll cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2586 1.3 christos }
2587 1.1 skrll
2588 1.1 skrll return &cache->sym[ent];
2589 1.1 skrll }
2590 1.1 skrll
2591 1.1 skrll /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2592 1.1 skrll section. */
2593 1.3 christos
2594 1.1 skrll asection *
2595 1.3 christos bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2596 1.1 skrll {
2597 1.3 christos if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2598 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2599 1.1 skrll return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2600 1.1 skrll }
2601 1.1 skrll
2602 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2603 1.9 christos {
2604 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2605 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2606 1.1 skrll };
2607 1.1 skrll
2608 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2609 1.9 christos {
2610 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2611 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2612 1.1 skrll };
2613 1.1 skrll
2614 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2615 1.9 christos {
2616 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2617 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2618 1.6 christos /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2619 1.9 christos unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2620 1.9 christos attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2621 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2622 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2623 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2624 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2625 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2626 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2627 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2628 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2629 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2630 1.1 skrll };
2631 1.1 skrll
2632 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2633 1.9 christos {
2634 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2635 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2636 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2637 1.1 skrll };
2638 1.1 skrll
2639 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2640 1.9 christos {
2641 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2642 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2643 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2644 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2645 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2646 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2647 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2648 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2649 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2650 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2651 1.1 skrll };
2652 1.1 skrll
2653 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2654 1.9 christos {
2655 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2656 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2657 1.1 skrll };
2658 1.1 skrll
2659 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2660 1.9 christos {
2661 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2662 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2663 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2664 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2665 1.1 skrll };
2666 1.1 skrll
2667 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2668 1.9 christos {
2669 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2670 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2671 1.1 skrll };
2672 1.1 skrll
2673 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2674 1.9 christos {
2675 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2676 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2677 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2678 1.1 skrll };
2679 1.1 skrll
2680 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2681 1.9 christos {
2682 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2683 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2684 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2685 1.1 skrll };
2686 1.1 skrll
2687 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2688 1.1 skrll {
2689 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2690 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2691 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2692 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2693 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2694 1.1 skrll };
2695 1.1 skrll
2696 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2697 1.1 skrll {
2698 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2699 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2700 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2701 1.1 skrll /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2702 1.9 christos this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2703 1.1 skrll { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2704 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2705 1.1 skrll };
2706 1.1 skrll
2707 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2708 1.9 christos {
2709 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2710 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2711 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2712 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2713 1.1 skrll };
2714 1.1 skrll
2715 1.9 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2716 1.9 christos {
2717 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2718 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2719 1.9 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2720 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2721 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2722 1.5 christos };
2723 1.1 skrll
2724 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2725 1.1 skrll {
2726 1.1 skrll special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2727 1.1 skrll special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2728 1.1 skrll special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2729 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'e' */
2730 1.1 skrll special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2731 1.1 skrll special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2732 1.1 skrll special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2733 1.1 skrll special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2734 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'j' */
2735 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'k' */
2736 1.1 skrll special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2737 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'm' */
2738 1.1 skrll special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2739 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'o' */
2740 1.1 skrll special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2741 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'q' */
2742 1.1 skrll special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2743 1.1 skrll special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2744 1.1 skrll special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2745 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'u' */
2746 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'v' */
2747 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'w' */
2748 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'x' */
2749 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'y' */
2750 1.1 skrll special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2751 1.1 skrll };
2752 1.1 skrll
2753 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2754 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2755 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2756 1.1 skrll unsigned int rela)
2757 1.1 skrll {
2758 1.1 skrll int i;
2759 1.1 skrll int len;
2760 1.1 skrll
2761 1.1 skrll len = strlen (name);
2762 1.1 skrll
2763 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2764 1.1 skrll {
2765 1.1 skrll int suffix_len;
2766 1.1 skrll int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2767 1.1 skrll
2768 1.1 skrll if (len < prefix_len)
2769 1.1 skrll continue;
2770 1.1 skrll if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2771 1.1 skrll continue;
2772 1.1 skrll
2773 1.1 skrll suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2774 1.1 skrll if (suffix_len <= 0)
2775 1.1 skrll {
2776 1.1 skrll if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2777 1.1 skrll {
2778 1.1 skrll if (suffix_len == 0)
2779 1.1 skrll continue;
2780 1.1 skrll if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2781 1.1 skrll && (suffix_len == -2
2782 1.1 skrll || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2783 1.1 skrll continue;
2784 1.1 skrll }
2785 1.1 skrll }
2786 1.1 skrll else
2787 1.1 skrll {
2788 1.1 skrll if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2789 1.1 skrll continue;
2790 1.1 skrll if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2791 1.1 skrll spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2792 1.1 skrll suffix_len) != 0)
2793 1.1 skrll continue;
2794 1.1 skrll }
2795 1.1 skrll return &spec[i];
2796 1.1 skrll }
2797 1.1 skrll
2798 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2799 1.1 skrll }
2800 1.1 skrll
2801 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2802 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2803 1.1 skrll {
2804 1.1 skrll int i;
2805 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2806 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2807 1.1 skrll
2808 1.1 skrll /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2809 1.1 skrll if (sec->name == NULL)
2810 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2811 1.1 skrll
2812 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2813 1.1 skrll spec = bed->special_sections;
2814 1.1 skrll if (spec)
2815 1.1 skrll {
2816 1.1 skrll spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2817 1.1 skrll bed->special_sections,
2818 1.1 skrll sec->use_rela_p);
2819 1.1 skrll if (spec != NULL)
2820 1.1 skrll return spec;
2821 1.1 skrll }
2822 1.1 skrll
2823 1.1 skrll if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2824 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2825 1.1 skrll
2826 1.1 skrll i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2827 1.1 skrll if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2828 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2829 1.1 skrll
2830 1.1 skrll spec = special_sections[i];
2831 1.1 skrll
2832 1.1 skrll if (spec == NULL)
2833 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2834 1.1 skrll
2835 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2836 1.1 skrll }
2837 1.1 skrll
2838 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2839 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2840 1.1 skrll {
2841 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2842 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2843 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2844 1.1 skrll
2845 1.1 skrll sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2846 1.3 christos if (sdata == NULL)
2847 1.9 christos {
2848 1.1 skrll sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2849 1.1 skrll sizeof (*sdata));
2850 1.1 skrll if (sdata == NULL)
2851 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2852 1.1 skrll sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2853 1.1 skrll }
2854 1.1 skrll
2855 1.1 skrll /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2856 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2857 1.1 skrll sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2858 1.1 skrll
2859 1.1 skrll /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2860 1.1 skrll flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2861 1.1 skrll anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2862 1.5 christos created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2863 1.5 christos set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2864 1.5 christos elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2865 1.5 christos output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2866 1.5 christos sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2867 1.1 skrll copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2868 1.1 skrll if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2869 1.1 skrll || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2870 1.5 christos {
2871 1.5 christos ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2872 1.5 christos if (ssect != NULL
2873 1.5 christos && (!sec->flags
2874 1.5 christos || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2875 1.1 skrll || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2876 1.1 skrll || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2877 1.1 skrll {
2878 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2879 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2880 1.1 skrll }
2881 1.1 skrll }
2882 1.1 skrll
2883 1.1 skrll return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2884 1.1 skrll }
2885 1.1 skrll
2886 1.1 skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2887 1.1 skrll
2888 1.1 skrll Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2889 1.1 skrll of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2890 1.1 skrll program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2891 1.1 skrll generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2892 1.1 skrll
2893 1.1 skrll Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2894 1.1 skrll (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2895 1.1 skrll system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2896 1.1 skrll but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2897 1.1 skrll file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2898 1.1 skrll of combined data+bss.
2899 1.1 skrll
2900 1.1 skrll To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2901 1.1 skrll for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2902 1.1 skrll the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2903 1.1 skrll by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2904 1.1 skrll into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2905 1.1 skrll
2906 1.1 skrll */
2907 1.1 skrll
2908 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2909 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2910 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2911 1.1 skrll int hdr_index,
2912 1.1 skrll const char *type_name)
2913 1.1 skrll {
2914 1.1 skrll asection *newsect;
2915 1.1 skrll char *name;
2916 1.1 skrll char namebuf[64];
2917 1.1 skrll size_t len;
2918 1.1 skrll int split;
2919 1.1 skrll
2920 1.1 skrll split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2921 1.1 skrll && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2922 1.1 skrll && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2923 1.1 skrll
2924 1.3 christos if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2925 1.1 skrll {
2926 1.3 christos sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2927 1.1 skrll len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2928 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2929 1.1 skrll if (!name)
2930 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2931 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2932 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2933 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
2934 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2935 1.1 skrll newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2936 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2937 1.1 skrll newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2938 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2939 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2940 1.1 skrll newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2941 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2942 1.1 skrll {
2943 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2944 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2945 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2946 1.1 skrll {
2947 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2948 1.1 skrll may be data. */
2949 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2950 1.1 skrll }
2951 1.1 skrll }
2952 1.1 skrll if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2953 1.1 skrll {
2954 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2955 1.1 skrll }
2956 1.1 skrll }
2957 1.1 skrll
2958 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2959 1.1 skrll {
2960 1.3 christos bfd_vma align;
2961 1.1 skrll
2962 1.3 christos sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2963 1.1 skrll len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2964 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2965 1.1 skrll if (!name)
2966 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2967 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2968 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2969 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
2970 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2971 1.1 skrll newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2972 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2973 1.1 skrll newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2974 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2975 1.1 skrll align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2976 1.1 skrll if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2977 1.1 skrll align = hdr->p_align;
2978 1.1 skrll newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2979 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2980 1.1 skrll {
2981 1.1 skrll /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2982 1.1 skrll not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2983 1.1 skrll assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2984 1.1 skrll executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2985 1.1 skrll section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2986 1.1 skrll always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2987 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2988 1.1 skrll newsect->size = 0;
2989 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2990 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2991 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2992 1.1 skrll }
2993 1.1 skrll if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2994 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2995 1.1 skrll }
2996 1.1 skrll
2997 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2998 1.1 skrll }
2999 1.3 christos
3000 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
3001 1.1 skrll bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3002 1.1 skrll {
3003 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3004 1.1 skrll
3005 1.1 skrll switch (hdr->p_type)
3006 1.3 christos {
3007 1.1 skrll case PT_NULL:
3008 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3009 1.3 christos
3010 1.1 skrll case PT_LOAD:
3011 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
3012 1.3 christos
3013 1.1 skrll case PT_DYNAMIC:
3014 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3015 1.3 christos
3016 1.1 skrll case PT_INTERP:
3017 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3018 1.3 christos
3019 1.1 skrll case PT_NOTE:
3020 1.9 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3021 1.9 christos return FALSE;
3022 1.1 skrll if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3023 1.1 skrll hdr->p_align))
3024 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3025 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3026 1.3 christos
3027 1.1 skrll case PT_SHLIB:
3028 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3029 1.3 christos
3030 1.1 skrll case PT_PHDR:
3031 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3032 1.3 christos
3033 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3034 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3035 1.1 skrll "eh_frame_hdr");
3036 1.3 christos
3037 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_STACK:
3038 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3039 1.3 christos
3040 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3041 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3042 1.1 skrll
3043 1.1 skrll default:
3044 1.3 christos /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3045 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3046 1.1 skrll return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3047 1.1 skrll }
3048 1.3 christos }
3049 1.3 christos
3050 1.3 christos /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3051 1.3 christos REL or RELA. */
3052 1.3 christos
3053 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3054 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3055 1.3 christos {
3056 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3057 1.3 christos {
3058 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3059 1.3 christos return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3060 1.3 christos }
3061 1.3 christos else
3062 1.3 christos return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3063 1.6 christos }
3064 1.6 christos
3065 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
3066 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3067 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3068 1.6 christos const char *sec_name,
3069 1.6 christos bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3070 1.6 christos {
3071 1.6 christos char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3072 1.6 christos sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3073 1.6 christos if (name == NULL)
3074 1.6 christos return FALSE;
3075 1.6 christos
3076 1.6 christos sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3077 1.6 christos rel_hdr->sh_name =
3078 1.6 christos (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3079 1.6 christos FALSE);
3080 1.6 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3081 1.6 christos return FALSE;
3082 1.6 christos
3083 1.6 christos return TRUE;
3084 1.3 christos }
3085 1.3 christos
3086 1.3 christos /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3087 1.3 christos containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3088 1.1 skrll USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3089 1.6 christos relocations. */
3090 1.1 skrll
3091 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
3092 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3093 1.6 christos struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3094 1.6 christos const char *sec_name,
3095 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3096 1.3 christos bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3097 1.1 skrll {
3098 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3099 1.3 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3100 1.7 christos
3101 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3102 1.1 skrll rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3103 1.6 christos reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3104 1.6 christos
3105 1.6 christos if (delay_st_name_p)
3106 1.6 christos rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3107 1.1 skrll else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3108 1.1 skrll use_rela_p))
3109 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3110 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3111 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3112 1.1 skrll ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3113 1.1 skrll : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3114 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3115 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3116 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3117 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3118 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3119 1.1 skrll
3120 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3121 1.3 christos }
3122 1.3 christos
3123 1.3 christos /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3124 1.3 christos
3125 1.3 christos int
3126 1.3 christos bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3127 1.3 christos {
3128 1.3 christos if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3129 1.3 christos && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3130 1.3 christos return SHT_NOBITS;
3131 1.3 christos return SHT_PROGBITS;
3132 1.3 christos }
3133 1.3 christos
3134 1.3 christos struct fake_section_arg
3135 1.3 christos {
3136 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3137 1.3 christos bfd_boolean failed;
3138 1.1 skrll };
3139 1.1 skrll
3140 1.1 skrll /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3141 1.3 christos
3142 1.1 skrll static void
3143 1.3 christos elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3144 1.1 skrll {
3145 1.3 christos struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3146 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3147 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3148 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3149 1.6 christos unsigned int sh_type;
3150 1.1 skrll const char *name = asect->name;
3151 1.3 christos bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3152 1.1 skrll
3153 1.1 skrll if (arg->failed)
3154 1.1 skrll {
3155 1.1 skrll /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3156 1.1 skrll loop. */
3157 1.1 skrll return;
3158 1.3 christos }
3159 1.1 skrll
3160 1.6 christos this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3161 1.6 christos
3162 1.6 christos if (arg->link_info)
3163 1.6 christos {
3164 1.6 christos /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3165 1.6 christos if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3166 1.6 christos && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3167 1.6 christos && name[1] == 'd'
3168 1.6 christos && name[6] == '_')
3169 1.6 christos {
3170 1.6 christos /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3171 1.6 christos compressed. */
3172 1.9 christos asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3173 1.6 christos
3174 1.6 christos /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3175 1.6 christos name to section name section after it is compressed in
3176 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3177 1.6 christos delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3178 1.6 christos }
3179 1.6 christos }
3180 1.6 christos else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3181 1.6 christos {
3182 1.6 christos /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3183 1.6 christos if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3184 1.6 christos {
3185 1.6 christos /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3186 1.6 christos convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3187 1.6 christos needed. */
3188 1.6 christos if (name[1] == 'z')
3189 1.6 christos {
3190 1.6 christos char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3191 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
3192 1.6 christos {
3193 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3194 1.6 christos return;
3195 1.6 christos }
3196 1.6 christos name = new_name;
3197 1.6 christos }
3198 1.6 christos }
3199 1.6 christos else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3200 1.6 christos {
3201 1.6 christos /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3202 1.6 christos section smaller. So only rename the section when
3203 1.6 christos compression has actually taken place. If input section
3204 1.6 christos name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3205 1.6 christos char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3206 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
3207 1.6 christos {
3208 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3209 1.6 christos return;
3210 1.6 christos }
3211 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3212 1.6 christos name = new_name;
3213 1.6 christos }
3214 1.6 christos }
3215 1.6 christos
3216 1.6 christos if (delay_st_name_p)
3217 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3218 1.6 christos else
3219 1.6 christos {
3220 1.6 christos this_hdr->sh_name
3221 1.6 christos = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3222 1.6 christos name, FALSE);
3223 1.6 christos if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3224 1.6 christos {
3225 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3226 1.1 skrll return;
3227 1.1 skrll }
3228 1.1 skrll }
3229 1.1 skrll
3230 1.1 skrll /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3231 1.1 skrll
3232 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3233 1.1 skrll || asect->user_set_vma)
3234 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3235 1.1 skrll else
3236 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3237 1.1 skrll
3238 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3239 1.6 christos this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3240 1.6 christos this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3241 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3242 1.9 christos if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3243 1.9 christos {
3244 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
3245 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3246 1.6 christos (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3247 1.6 christos abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3248 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3249 1.1 skrll return;
3250 1.1 skrll }
3251 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3252 1.1 skrll /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3253 1.1 skrll copy_private_section_data. */
3254 1.1 skrll
3255 1.1 skrll this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3256 1.1 skrll this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3257 1.1 skrll
3258 1.1 skrll /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3259 1.1 skrll asect->flags. */
3260 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3261 1.3 christos sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3262 1.1 skrll else
3263 1.1 skrll sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3264 1.1 skrll
3265 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3266 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3267 1.1 skrll else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3268 1.1 skrll && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3269 1.1 skrll && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3270 1.1 skrll {
3271 1.1 skrll /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3272 1.1 skrll allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3273 1.9 christos non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3274 1.13 christos to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3275 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
3276 1.1 skrll (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3277 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3278 1.1 skrll }
3279 1.1 skrll
3280 1.1 skrll switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3281 1.1 skrll {
3282 1.1 skrll default:
3283 1.1 skrll break;
3284 1.7 christos
3285 1.7 christos case SHT_STRTAB:
3286 1.7 christos case SHT_NOTE:
3287 1.7 christos case SHT_NOBITS:
3288 1.7 christos case SHT_PROGBITS:
3289 1.1 skrll break;
3290 1.1 skrll
3291 1.1 skrll case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3292 1.7 christos case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3293 1.1 skrll case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3294 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3295 1.1 skrll break;
3296 1.1 skrll
3297 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH:
3298 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3299 1.1 skrll break;
3300 1.1 skrll
3301 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM:
3302 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3303 1.1 skrll break;
3304 1.1 skrll
3305 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3306 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3307 1.1 skrll break;
3308 1.1 skrll
3309 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
3310 1.1 skrll if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3311 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3312 1.1 skrll break;
3313 1.1 skrll
3314 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
3315 1.1 skrll if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3316 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3317 1.1 skrll break;
3318 1.1 skrll
3319 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
3320 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3321 1.1 skrll break;
3322 1.1 skrll
3323 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3324 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3325 1.1 skrll /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3326 1.1 skrll cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3327 1.1 skrll zero. */
3328 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3329 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3330 1.1 skrll else
3331 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3332 1.1 skrll || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3333 1.1 skrll break;
3334 1.1 skrll
3335 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3336 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3337 1.1 skrll /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3338 1.1 skrll cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3339 1.1 skrll zero. */
3340 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3341 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3342 1.1 skrll else
3343 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3344 1.1 skrll || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3345 1.1 skrll break;
3346 1.1 skrll
3347 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
3348 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3349 1.1 skrll break;
3350 1.1 skrll
3351 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3352 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3353 1.1 skrll break;
3354 1.1 skrll }
3355 1.1 skrll
3356 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3357 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3358 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3359 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3360 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3361 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3362 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3363 1.1 skrll {
3364 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3365 1.7 christos this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3366 1.7 christos }
3367 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3368 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3369 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3370 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3371 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3372 1.1 skrll {
3373 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3374 1.1 skrll if (asect->size == 0
3375 1.1 skrll && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3376 1.1 skrll {
3377 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3378 1.1 skrll
3379 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3380 1.1 skrll if (o != NULL)
3381 1.1 skrll {
3382 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3383 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3384 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3385 1.1 skrll }
3386 1.3 christos }
3387 1.3 christos }
3388 1.3 christos if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3389 1.3 christos this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3390 1.3 christos
3391 1.3 christos /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3392 1.3 christos SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3393 1.3 christos this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3394 1.3 christos create the other. */
3395 1.3 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3396 1.3 christos {
3397 1.3 christos /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3398 1.3 christos needed. */
3399 1.3 christos if (arg->link_info
3400 1.6 christos /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3401 1.6 christos && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3402 1.3 christos && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3403 1.3 christos || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3404 1.9 christos {
3405 1.9 christos if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3406 1.3 christos && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3407 1.3 christos FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3408 1.3 christos {
3409 1.3 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3410 1.3 christos return;
3411 1.9 christos }
3412 1.9 christos if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3413 1.3 christos && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3414 1.3 christos TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3415 1.3 christos {
3416 1.3 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3417 1.3 christos return;
3418 1.3 christos }
3419 1.3 christos }
3420 1.3 christos else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3421 1.6 christos (asect->use_rela_p
3422 1.6 christos ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3423 1.6 christos name,
3424 1.9 christos asect->use_rela_p,
3425 1.3 christos delay_st_name_p))
3426 1.9 christos {
3427 1.9 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3428 1.3 christos return;
3429 1.1 skrll }
3430 1.1 skrll }
3431 1.1 skrll
3432 1.1 skrll /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3433 1.1 skrll sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3434 1.9 christos if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3435 1.9 christos && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3436 1.9 christos {
3437 1.9 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3438 1.1 skrll return;
3439 1.1 skrll }
3440 1.1 skrll
3441 1.1 skrll if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3442 1.1 skrll {
3443 1.1 skrll /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3444 1.1 skrll called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3445 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3446 1.1 skrll }
3447 1.2 skrll }
3448 1.2 skrll
3449 1.2 skrll /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3450 1.2 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3451 1.1 skrll when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3452 1.1 skrll from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3453 1.1 skrll
3454 1.1 skrll void
3455 1.3 christos bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3456 1.1 skrll {
3457 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3458 1.1 skrll asection *elt, *first;
3459 1.1 skrll unsigned char *loc;
3460 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean gas;
3461 1.1 skrll
3462 1.1 skrll /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3463 1.1 skrll elfxx-ia64.c. */
3464 1.1 skrll if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3465 1.1 skrll || *failedptr)
3466 1.2 skrll return;
3467 1.2 skrll
3468 1.2 skrll if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3469 1.2 skrll {
3470 1.2 skrll unsigned long symindx = 0;
3471 1.2 skrll
3472 1.2 skrll /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3473 1.2 skrll generic linker. */
3474 1.2 skrll if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3475 1.2 skrll symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3476 1.2 skrll
3477 1.2 skrll if (symindx == 0)
3478 1.2 skrll {
3479 1.2 skrll /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3480 1.2 skrll elf_section_syms. */
3481 1.2 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3482 1.2 skrll symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3483 1.2 skrll }
3484 1.2 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3485 1.2 skrll }
3486 1.2 skrll else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3487 1.2 skrll {
3488 1.2 skrll /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3489 1.9 christos signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3490 1.9 christos set until all local symbols are output. */
3491 1.9 christos asection *igroup;
3492 1.9 christos struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3493 1.2 skrll unsigned long symndx;
3494 1.2 skrll unsigned long extsymoff;
3495 1.9 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3496 1.9 christos
3497 1.9 christos /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3498 1.9 christos then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3499 1.9 christos the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3500 1.9 christos igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3501 1.9 christos sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3502 1.2 skrll symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3503 1.2 skrll extsymoff = 0;
3504 1.2 skrll if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3505 1.2 skrll {
3506 1.2 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3507 1.2 skrll
3508 1.2 skrll symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3509 1.2 skrll extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3510 1.2 skrll }
3511 1.2 skrll h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3512 1.2 skrll while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3513 1.2 skrll || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3514 1.2 skrll h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3515 1.1 skrll
3516 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3517 1.1 skrll }
3518 1.1 skrll
3519 1.1 skrll /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3520 1.1 skrll gas = TRUE;
3521 1.1 skrll if (sec->contents == NULL)
3522 1.3 christos {
3523 1.1 skrll gas = FALSE;
3524 1.1 skrll sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3525 1.1 skrll
3526 1.1 skrll /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3527 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3528 1.1 skrll if (sec->contents == NULL)
3529 1.1 skrll {
3530 1.1 skrll *failedptr = TRUE;
3531 1.1 skrll return;
3532 1.1 skrll }
3533 1.1 skrll }
3534 1.1 skrll
3535 1.1 skrll loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3536 1.1 skrll
3537 1.1 skrll /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3538 1.1 skrll squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3539 1.1 skrll start of the input section group. */
3540 1.1 skrll first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3541 1.1 skrll
3542 1.1 skrll /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3543 1.1 skrll indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3544 1.1 skrll just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3545 1.1 skrll directives, not that it matters. */
3546 1.1 skrll while (elt != NULL)
3547 1.1 skrll {
3548 1.1 skrll asection *s;
3549 1.1 skrll
3550 1.1 skrll s = elt;
3551 1.3 christos if (!gas)
3552 1.3 christos s = s->output_section;
3553 1.3 christos if (s != NULL
3554 1.9 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3555 1.9 christos {
3556 1.3 christos struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3557 1.9 christos struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3558 1.9 christos
3559 1.9 christos if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3560 1.9 christos && (gas
3561 1.9 christos || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3562 1.9 christos && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3563 1.9 christos {
3564 1.9 christos elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3565 1.9 christos loc -= 4;
3566 1.9 christos H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3567 1.9 christos }
3568 1.9 christos if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3569 1.9 christos && (gas
3570 1.9 christos || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3571 1.9 christos && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3572 1.9 christos {
3573 1.9 christos elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3574 1.9 christos loc -= 4;
3575 1.3 christos H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3576 1.9 christos }
3577 1.3 christos loc -= 4;
3578 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3579 1.1 skrll }
3580 1.1 skrll elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3581 1.1 skrll if (elt == first)
3582 1.1 skrll break;
3583 1.9 christos }
3584 1.9 christos
3585 1.1 skrll loc -= 4;
3586 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3587 1.1 skrll
3588 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3589 1.9 christos }
3590 1.9 christos
3591 1.9 christos /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3592 1.6 christos .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3593 1.6 christos relocations apply. */
3594 1.9 christos
3595 1.9 christos asection *
3596 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3597 1.9 christos {
3598 1.9 christos /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3599 1.9 christos section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3600 1.9 christos if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3601 1.9 christos && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3602 1.9 christos {
3603 1.9 christos asection *sec;
3604 1.9 christos
3605 1.9 christos name = ".got.plt";
3606 1.9 christos sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3607 1.9 christos if (sec != NULL)
3608 1.9 christos return sec;
3609 1.9 christos name = ".got";
3610 1.9 christos }
3611 1.9 christos
3612 1.9 christos return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3613 1.9 christos }
3614 1.9 christos
3615 1.9 christos /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3616 1.9 christos
3617 1.6 christos static asection *
3618 1.6 christos elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3619 1.6 christos {
3620 1.6 christos const char *name;
3621 1.9 christos unsigned int type;
3622 1.6 christos bfd *abfd;
3623 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3624 1.6 christos
3625 1.6 christos type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3626 1.6 christos if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3627 1.6 christos return NULL;
3628 1.6 christos
3629 1.9 christos /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3630 1.9 christos name = reloc_sec->name;
3631 1.9 christos if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3632 1.9 christos return NULL;
3633 1.9 christos name += 4;
3634 1.6 christos if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3635 1.6 christos return NULL;
3636 1.9 christos
3637 1.9 christos abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3638 1.6 christos bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3639 1.6 christos return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3640 1.1 skrll }
3641 1.1 skrll
3642 1.1 skrll /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3643 1.1 skrll too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3644 1.1 skrll in here too, while we're at it. */
3645 1.1 skrll
3646 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3647 1.1 skrll assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3648 1.1 skrll {
3649 1.6 christos struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3650 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
3651 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_number;
3652 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3653 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3654 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3655 1.1 skrll
3656 1.1 skrll section_number = 1;
3657 1.1 skrll
3658 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3659 1.9 christos
3660 1.1 skrll /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3661 1.7 christos if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3662 1.7 christos {
3663 1.1 skrll size_t reloc_count = 0;
3664 1.1 skrll
3665 1.1 skrll /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3666 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3667 1.1 skrll {
3668 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3669 1.1 skrll
3670 1.1 skrll if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3671 1.1 skrll {
3672 1.1 skrll if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3673 1.1 skrll {
3674 1.1 skrll /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3675 1.1 skrll bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3676 1.1 skrll abfd->section_count--;
3677 1.1 skrll }
3678 1.1 skrll else
3679 1.7 christos d->this_idx = section_number++;
3680 1.7 christos }
3681 1.7 christos
3682 1.1 skrll /* Count relocations. */
3683 1.7 christos reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3684 1.7 christos }
3685 1.7 christos
3686 1.7 christos /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3687 1.1 skrll if (reloc_count == 0)
3688 1.1 skrll abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3689 1.1 skrll }
3690 1.1 skrll
3691 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3692 1.1 skrll {
3693 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3694 1.1 skrll
3695 1.6 christos if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3696 1.6 christos d->this_idx = section_number++;
3697 1.3 christos if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3698 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3699 1.3 christos if (d->rel.hdr)
3700 1.6 christos {
3701 1.6 christos d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3702 1.1 skrll if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3703 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3704 1.3 christos }
3705 1.1 skrll else
3706 1.3 christos d->rel.idx = 0;
3707 1.1 skrll
3708 1.3 christos if (d->rela.hdr)
3709 1.6 christos {
3710 1.6 christos d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3711 1.1 skrll if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3712 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3713 1.3 christos }
3714 1.1 skrll else
3715 1.1 skrll d->rela.idx = 0;
3716 1.3 christos }
3717 1.3 christos
3718 1.3 christos need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3719 1.3 christos || (link_info == NULL
3720 1.3 christos && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3721 1.1 skrll == HAS_RELOC)));
3722 1.6 christos if (need_symtab)
3723 1.1 skrll {
3724 1.1 skrll elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3725 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3726 1.6 christos if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3727 1.6 christos {
3728 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
3729 1.6 christos
3730 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3731 1.6 christos
3732 1.6 christos entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3733 1.6 christos entry->ndx = section_number++;
3734 1.1 skrll elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3735 1.1 skrll entry->hdr.sh_name
3736 1.6 christos = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3737 1.1 skrll ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3738 1.1 skrll if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3739 1.6 christos return FALSE;
3740 1.1 skrll }
3741 1.1 skrll elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3742 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3743 1.9 christos }
3744 1.9 christos
3745 1.9 christos elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3746 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3747 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3748 1.5 christos
3749 1.9 christos if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3750 1.13 christos {
3751 1.5 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3752 1.5 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3753 1.5 christos abfd, section_number);
3754 1.5 christos return FALSE;
3755 1.1 skrll }
3756 1.1 skrll
3757 1.1 skrll elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3758 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3759 1.1 skrll
3760 1.3 christos /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3761 1.9 christos indices. */
3762 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3763 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3764 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3765 1.3 christos return FALSE;
3766 1.9 christos
3767 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3768 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3769 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3770 1.1 skrll {
3771 1.1 skrll bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3772 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3773 1.1 skrll }
3774 1.1 skrll
3775 1.6 christos elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3776 1.3 christos
3777 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3778 1.6 christos if (need_symtab)
3779 1.1 skrll {
3780 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3781 1.6 christos if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3782 1.6 christos {
3783 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3784 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3785 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3786 1.6 christos entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3787 1.6 christos }
3788 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3789 1.1 skrll t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3790 1.1 skrll }
3791 1.1 skrll
3792 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3793 1.1 skrll {
3794 1.3 christos asection *s;
3795 1.3 christos
3796 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3797 1.3 christos
3798 1.3 christos i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3799 1.3 christos if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3800 1.3 christos i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3801 1.1 skrll if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3802 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3803 1.1 skrll
3804 1.1 skrll /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3805 1.1 skrll
3806 1.1 skrll /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3807 1.3 christos table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3808 1.1 skrll the relocation entries apply. */
3809 1.6 christos if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3810 1.3 christos {
3811 1.6 christos d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3812 1.1 skrll d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3813 1.3 christos d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3814 1.1 skrll }
3815 1.6 christos if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3816 1.3 christos {
3817 1.6 christos d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3818 1.1 skrll d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3819 1.1 skrll d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3820 1.1 skrll }
3821 1.1 skrll
3822 1.1 skrll /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3823 1.1 skrll if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3824 1.1 skrll {
3825 1.1 skrll s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3826 1.1 skrll if (s)
3827 1.1 skrll {
3828 1.1 skrll /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3829 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
3830 1.5 christos {
3831 1.1 skrll /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3832 1.1 skrll if (discarded_section (s))
3833 1.9 christos {
3834 1.9 christos asection *kept;
3835 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
3836 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3837 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3838 1.1 skrll " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3839 1.1 skrll abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3840 1.1 skrll s, s->owner);
3841 1.1 skrll /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3842 1.1 skrll size as the discarded one. */
3843 1.1 skrll kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3844 1.1 skrll if (kept == NULL)
3845 1.1 skrll {
3846 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3847 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3848 1.1 skrll }
3849 1.1 skrll s = kept;
3850 1.1 skrll }
3851 1.1 skrll
3852 1.1 skrll s = s->output_section;
3853 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3854 1.1 skrll }
3855 1.1 skrll else
3856 1.1 skrll {
3857 1.1 skrll /* Handle objcopy. */
3858 1.9 christos if (s->output_section == NULL)
3859 1.9 christos {
3860 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
3861 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3862 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3863 1.1 skrll " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3864 1.1 skrll abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3865 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3866 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3867 1.1 skrll }
3868 1.1 skrll s = s->output_section;
3869 1.1 skrll }
3870 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3871 1.1 skrll }
3872 1.1 skrll else
3873 1.1 skrll {
3874 1.1 skrll /* PR 290:
3875 1.1 skrll The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3876 1.1 skrll SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3877 1.1 skrll sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3878 1.1 skrll where s is NULL. */
3879 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3880 1.1 skrll = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3881 1.9 christos if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3882 1.13 christos bed->link_order_error_handler
3883 1.1 skrll /* xgettext:c-format */
3884 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3885 1.1 skrll abfd, sec);
3886 1.1 skrll }
3887 1.1 skrll }
3888 1.1 skrll
3889 1.1 skrll switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3890 1.1 skrll {
3891 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
3892 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
3893 1.1 skrll /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3894 1.1 skrll section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3895 1.1 skrll table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3896 1.1 skrll which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3897 1.1 skrll allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3898 1.1 skrll FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3899 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3900 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3901 1.9 christos d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3902 1.1 skrll
3903 1.6 christos s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3904 1.6 christos if (s != NULL)
3905 1.6 christos {
3906 1.6 christos d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3907 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3908 1.1 skrll }
3909 1.1 skrll break;
3910 1.1 skrll
3911 1.1 skrll case SHT_STRTAB:
3912 1.1 skrll /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3913 1.1 skrll string section. We look for a section with the same name
3914 1.1 skrll but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3915 1.1 skrll field to point to this section. */
3916 1.1 skrll if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3917 1.1 skrll && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3918 1.1 skrll {
3919 1.1 skrll size_t len;
3920 1.1 skrll char *alc;
3921 1.3 christos
3922 1.1 skrll len = strlen (sec->name);
3923 1.1 skrll alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3924 1.1 skrll if (alc == NULL)
3925 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3926 1.1 skrll memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3927 1.1 skrll alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3928 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3929 1.1 skrll free (alc);
3930 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3931 1.1 skrll {
3932 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3933 1.1 skrll
3934 1.1 skrll /* This is a .stab section. */
3935 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3936 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3937 1.1 skrll = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3938 1.1 skrll }
3939 1.1 skrll }
3940 1.1 skrll break;
3941 1.1 skrll
3942 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3943 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM:
3944 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3945 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3946 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3947 1.1 skrll used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3948 1.1 skrll version strings. */
3949 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3950 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3951 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3952 1.1 skrll break;
3953 1.1 skrll
3954 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3955 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3956 1.1 skrll list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3957 1.1 skrll the version strings. */
3958 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3959 1.1 skrll ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3960 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3961 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3962 1.1 skrll break;
3963 1.1 skrll
3964 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH:
3965 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3966 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
3967 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3968 1.1 skrll this hash table or version table is for. */
3969 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3970 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3971 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3972 1.1 skrll break;
3973 1.6 christos
3974 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
3975 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3976 1.1 skrll }
3977 1.6 christos }
3978 1.6 christos
3979 1.6 christos /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3980 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3981 1.1 skrll debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3982 1.1 skrll
3983 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3984 1.1 skrll }
3985 1.1 skrll
3986 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3987 1.1 skrll sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3988 1.1 skrll {
3989 1.1 skrll /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3990 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3991 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3992 1.3 christos return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3993 1.1 skrll
3994 1.1 skrll return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3995 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3996 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3997 1.9 christos }
3998 1.9 christos
3999 1.9 christos /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4000 1.9 christos SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4001 1.9 christos SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4002 1.9 christos the beginning of that array.
4003 1.9 christos
4004 1.9 christos Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4005 1.9 christos
4006 1.9 christos unsigned int
4007 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4008 1.9 christos asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4009 1.9 christos {
4010 1.9 christos long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4011 1.9 christos
4012 1.9 christos for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4013 1.9 christos {
4014 1.9 christos asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4015 1.9 christos char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4016 1.9 christos struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4017 1.9 christos
4018 1.9 christos if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4019 1.9 christos continue;
4020 1.9 christos
4021 1.9 christos h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4022 1.9 christos if (h == NULL)
4023 1.9 christos continue;
4024 1.9 christos if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4025 1.9 christos continue;
4026 1.9 christos if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4027 1.9 christos continue;
4028 1.9 christos
4029 1.9 christos syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4030 1.9 christos }
4031 1.9 christos
4032 1.9 christos syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4033 1.9 christos
4034 1.9 christos return dst_count;
4035 1.1 skrll }
4036 1.5 christos
4037 1.1 skrll /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4038 1.1 skrll output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4039 1.1 skrll
4040 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4041 1.5 christos ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4042 1.5 christos {
4043 1.13 christos elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4044 1.13 christos
4045 1.13 christos if (sym == NULL)
4046 1.5 christos return FALSE;
4047 1.5 christos
4048 1.5 christos if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4049 1.13 christos return FALSE;
4050 1.13 christos
4051 1.13 christos if (sym->section == NULL)
4052 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4053 1.5 christos
4054 1.5 christos type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4055 1.5 christos return ((type_ptr != NULL
4056 1.5 christos && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4057 1.13 christos && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4058 1.13 christos || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4059 1.5 christos || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4060 1.5 christos && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4061 1.1 skrll && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4062 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4063 1.5 christos }
4064 1.5 christos
4065 1.5 christos /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4066 1.1 skrll all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4067 1.6 christos
4068 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4069 1.1 skrll elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4070 1.1 skrll {
4071 1.1 skrll unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4072 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4073 1.1 skrll asymbol **sect_syms;
4074 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4075 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4076 1.6 christos unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4077 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4078 1.1 skrll unsigned int max_index = 0;
4079 1.1 skrll unsigned int idx;
4080 1.1 skrll asection *asect;
4081 1.1 skrll asymbol **new_syms;
4082 1.1 skrll
4083 1.1 skrll #ifdef DEBUG
4084 1.1 skrll fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4085 1.1 skrll fflush (stderr);
4086 1.1 skrll #endif
4087 1.1 skrll
4088 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4089 1.1 skrll {
4090 1.1 skrll if (max_index < asect->index)
4091 1.1 skrll max_index = asect->index;
4092 1.1 skrll }
4093 1.3 christos
4094 1.1 skrll max_index++;
4095 1.1 skrll sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4096 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms == NULL)
4097 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4098 1.1 skrll elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4099 1.1 skrll elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4100 1.1 skrll
4101 1.1 skrll /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4102 1.1 skrll decided to output. */
4103 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4104 1.1 skrll {
4105 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4106 1.1 skrll
4107 1.5 christos if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4108 1.5 christos && sym->value == 0
4109 1.1 skrll && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4110 1.1 skrll && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4111 1.1 skrll {
4112 1.1 skrll asection *sec = sym->section;
4113 1.1 skrll
4114 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner != abfd)
4115 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
4116 1.1 skrll
4117 1.1 skrll sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4118 1.1 skrll }
4119 1.1 skrll }
4120 1.1 skrll
4121 1.1 skrll /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4122 1.5 christos for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4123 1.5 christos {
4124 1.5 christos if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4125 1.1 skrll num_globals++;
4126 1.1 skrll else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4127 1.1 skrll num_locals++;
4128 1.1 skrll }
4129 1.1 skrll
4130 1.1 skrll /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4131 1.1 skrll sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4132 1.1 skrll eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4133 1.1 skrll at least in that case. */
4134 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4135 1.1 skrll {
4136 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4137 1.1 skrll {
4138 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4139 1.1 skrll num_locals++;
4140 1.1 skrll else
4141 1.1 skrll num_globals++;
4142 1.1 skrll }
4143 1.1 skrll }
4144 1.3 christos
4145 1.9 christos /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4146 1.1 skrll new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4147 1.1 skrll sizeof (asymbol *));
4148 1.1 skrll
4149 1.1 skrll if (new_syms == NULL)
4150 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4151 1.1 skrll
4152 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4153 1.1 skrll {
4154 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4155 1.5 christos unsigned int i;
4156 1.5 christos
4157 1.5 christos if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4158 1.1 skrll i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4159 1.1 skrll else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4160 1.5 christos i = num_locals2++;
4161 1.1 skrll else
4162 1.1 skrll continue;
4163 1.1 skrll new_syms[i] = sym;
4164 1.1 skrll sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4165 1.1 skrll }
4166 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4167 1.1 skrll {
4168 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4169 1.1 skrll {
4170 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4171 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4172 1.1 skrll
4173 1.1 skrll sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4174 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4175 1.1 skrll i = num_locals2++;
4176 1.1 skrll else
4177 1.1 skrll i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4178 1.1 skrll new_syms[i] = sym;
4179 1.1 skrll sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4180 1.1 skrll }
4181 1.1 skrll }
4182 1.1 skrll
4183 1.6 christos bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4184 1.1 skrll
4185 1.1 skrll *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4186 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4187 1.1 skrll }
4188 1.1 skrll
4189 1.1 skrll /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4190 1.1 skrll ELF data structure. */
4191 1.1 skrll
4192 1.1 skrll static inline file_ptr
4193 1.1 skrll align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4194 1.1 skrll {
4195 1.1 skrll return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4196 1.1 skrll }
4197 1.1 skrll
4198 1.1 skrll /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4199 1.1 skrll required section alignment. */
4200 1.1 skrll
4201 1.1 skrll file_ptr
4202 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4203 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset,
4204 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean align)
4205 1.1 skrll {
4206 1.1 skrll if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4207 1.1 skrll offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4208 1.1 skrll i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4209 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4210 1.1 skrll i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4211 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4212 1.1 skrll offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4213 1.1 skrll return offset;
4214 1.1 skrll }
4215 1.1 skrll
4216 1.1 skrll /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4217 1.1 skrll otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4218 1.1 skrll is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4219 1.1 skrll
4220 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
4221 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4222 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4223 1.3 christos {
4224 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4225 1.6 christos struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4226 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean failed;
4227 1.3 christos struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4228 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4229 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4230 1.1 skrll
4231 1.1 skrll if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4232 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4233 1.1 skrll
4234 1.1 skrll /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4235 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4236 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4237 1.1 skrll
4238 1.1 skrll if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4239 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4240 1.6 christos
4241 1.1 skrll /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4242 1.3 christos (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4243 1.3 christos
4244 1.3 christos fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4245 1.3 christos fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4246 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4247 1.1 skrll if (fsargs.failed)
4248 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4249 1.1 skrll
4250 1.1 skrll if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4251 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4252 1.3 christos
4253 1.3 christos /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4254 1.3 christos need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4255 1.3 christos && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4256 1.3 christos || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4257 1.1 skrll == HAS_RELOC)));
4258 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
4259 1.1 skrll {
4260 1.1 skrll /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4261 1.1 skrll int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4262 1.1 skrll
4263 1.1 skrll if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4264 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4265 1.3 christos }
4266 1.1 skrll
4267 1.1 skrll failed = FALSE;
4268 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL)
4269 1.1 skrll {
4270 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4271 1.1 skrll if (failed)
4272 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4273 1.1 skrll }
4274 1.1 skrll
4275 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4276 1.7 christos /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4277 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4278 1.6 christos shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4279 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4280 1.1 skrll /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4281 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4282 1.6 christos shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4283 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4284 1.1 skrll /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4285 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4286 1.1 skrll
4287 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4288 1.3 christos return FALSE;
4289 1.1 skrll
4290 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
4291 1.1 skrll {
4292 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
4293 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4294 1.1 skrll
4295 1.6 christos off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4296 1.1 skrll
4297 1.1 skrll hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4298 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4299 1.6 christos
4300 1.6 christos if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4301 1.6 christos {
4302 1.6 christos hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4303 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4304 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4305 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4306 1.1 skrll }
4307 1.1 skrll
4308 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4309 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4310 1.1 skrll
4311 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4312 1.1 skrll
4313 1.1 skrll /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4314 1.6 christos out. */
4315 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4316 1.6 christos || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4317 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4318 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4319 1.1 skrll }
4320 1.1 skrll
4321 1.1 skrll abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4322 1.1 skrll
4323 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4324 1.1 skrll }
4325 1.1 skrll
4326 1.1 skrll /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4327 1.1 skrll get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4328 1.1 skrll
4329 1.1 skrll static bfd_size_type
4330 1.1 skrll get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4331 1.12 joerg {
4332 1.1 skrll size_t segs;
4333 1.1 skrll asection *s, *s2;
4334 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4335 1.1 skrll
4336 1.1 skrll /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4337 1.1 skrll and one for data. */
4338 1.1 skrll segs = 2;
4339 1.12 joerg
4340 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4341 1.1 skrll s2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4342 1.12 joerg if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4343 1.1 skrll {
4344 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4345 1.12 joerg }
4346 1.1 skrll
4347 1.1 skrll if (s2 != NULL && (s2->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4348 1.1 skrll {
4349 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4350 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4351 1.12 joerg }
4352 1.12 joerg
4353 1.12 joerg if ((s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) ||
4354 1.12 joerg (s2 != NULL && (s2->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0))
4355 1.12 joerg {
4356 1.12 joerg /*
4357 1.12 joerg * If either a PT_INTERP or PT_DYNAMIC segment is created,
4358 1.12 joerg * also create a PT_PHDR segment.
4359 1.12 joerg */
4360 1.12 joerg ++segs;
4361 1.1 skrll }
4362 1.1 skrll
4363 1.1 skrll if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4364 1.1 skrll {
4365 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4366 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4367 1.6 christos }
4368 1.1 skrll
4369 1.1 skrll if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4370 1.1 skrll {
4371 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4372 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4373 1.6 christos }
4374 1.1 skrll
4375 1.1 skrll if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4376 1.1 skrll {
4377 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4378 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4379 1.1 skrll }
4380 1.1 skrll
4381 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4382 1.1 skrll {
4383 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4384 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4385 1.1 skrll {
4386 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4387 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4388 1.1 skrll /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4389 1.1 skrll for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4390 1.1 skrll gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4391 1.1 skrll (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4392 1.1 skrll each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4393 1.1 skrll so we check whether the sections are correctly
4394 1.1 skrll aligned. */
4395 1.1 skrll if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4396 1.1 skrll while (s->next != NULL
4397 1.1 skrll && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4398 1.1 skrll && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4399 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4400 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4401 1.1 skrll }
4402 1.1 skrll }
4403 1.1 skrll
4404 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4405 1.1 skrll {
4406 1.1 skrll if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4407 1.1 skrll {
4408 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4409 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4410 1.1 skrll break;
4411 1.1 skrll }
4412 1.1 skrll }
4413 1.9 christos
4414 1.9 christos bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4415 1.9 christos
4416 1.9 christos if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4417 1.9 christos {
4418 1.9 christos /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4419 1.9 christos unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4420 1.9 christos for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4421 1.9 christos if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4422 1.9 christos {
4423 1.9 christos if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4424 1.9 christos > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4425 1.9 christos {
4426 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
4427 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
4428 1.9 christos (_("%pB: GNU_MBIN section `%pA' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4429 1.9 christos abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4430 1.9 christos continue;
4431 1.9 christos }
4432 1.9 christos /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4433 1.9 christos if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4434 1.9 christos s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4435 1.9 christos segs ++;
4436 1.9 christos }
4437 1.9 christos }
4438 1.9 christos
4439 1.1 skrll /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4440 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4441 1.1 skrll {
4442 1.1 skrll int a;
4443 1.1 skrll
4444 1.1 skrll a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4445 1.1 skrll if (a == -1)
4446 1.1 skrll abort ();
4447 1.1 skrll segs += a;
4448 1.1 skrll }
4449 1.1 skrll
4450 1.1 skrll return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4451 1.1 skrll }
4452 1.1 skrll
4453 1.1 skrll /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4454 1.1 skrll
4455 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4456 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4457 1.1 skrll {
4458 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4459 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4460 1.1 skrll
4461 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4462 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
4463 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++)
4464 1.1 skrll {
4465 1.1 skrll int i;
4466 1.1 skrll
4467 1.1 skrll for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4468 1.1 skrll if (m->sections[i] == section)
4469 1.1 skrll return p;
4470 1.1 skrll }
4471 1.1 skrll
4472 1.1 skrll return NULL;
4473 1.1 skrll }
4474 1.1 skrll
4475 1.1 skrll /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4476 1.1 skrll
4477 1.1 skrll static struct elf_segment_map *
4478 1.1 skrll make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4479 1.1 skrll asection **sections,
4480 1.1 skrll unsigned int from,
4481 1.1 skrll unsigned int to,
4482 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr)
4483 1.1 skrll {
4484 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4485 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4486 1.1 skrll asection **hdrpp;
4487 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
4488 1.1 skrll
4489 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4490 1.1 skrll amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4491 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4492 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4493 1.1 skrll return NULL;
4494 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4495 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4496 1.1 skrll for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4497 1.1 skrll m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4498 1.1 skrll m->count = to - from;
4499 1.1 skrll
4500 1.1 skrll if (from == 0 && phdr)
4501 1.1 skrll {
4502 1.1 skrll /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4503 1.1 skrll m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4504 1.1 skrll m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4505 1.1 skrll }
4506 1.1 skrll
4507 1.1 skrll return m;
4508 1.1 skrll }
4509 1.1 skrll
4510 1.1 skrll /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4511 1.1 skrll on failure. */
4512 1.1 skrll
4513 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *
4514 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4515 1.1 skrll {
4516 1.3 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
4517 1.9 christos
4518 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4519 1.1 skrll sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4520 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4521 1.1 skrll return NULL;
4522 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4523 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4524 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
4525 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4526 1.1 skrll
4527 1.1 skrll return m;
4528 1.1 skrll }
4529 1.1 skrll
4530 1.1 skrll /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4531 1.1 skrll
4532 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4533 1.1 skrll elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4534 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *info,
4535 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4536 1.1 skrll {
4537 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **m;
4538 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4539 1.1 skrll
4540 1.1 skrll /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4541 1.1 skrll not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4542 1.1 skrll sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4543 1.6 christos sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4544 1.1 skrll removed. */
4545 1.1 skrll m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4546 1.1 skrll while (*m)
4547 1.1 skrll {
4548 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, new_count;
4549 1.1 skrll
4550 1.1 skrll for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4551 1.1 skrll {
4552 1.1 skrll if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4553 1.1 skrll && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4554 1.1 skrll || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4555 1.1 skrll {
4556 1.1 skrll (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4557 1.1 skrll new_count++;
4558 1.1 skrll }
4559 1.1 skrll }
4560 1.9 christos (*m)->count = new_count;
4561 1.9 christos
4562 1.9 christos if (remove_empty_load
4563 1.9 christos && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4564 1.1 skrll && (*m)->count == 0
4565 1.1 skrll && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4566 1.1 skrll *m = (*m)->next;
4567 1.1 skrll else
4568 1.1 skrll m = &(*m)->next;
4569 1.1 skrll }
4570 1.1 skrll
4571 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4572 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4573 1.1 skrll {
4574 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4575 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4576 1.1 skrll }
4577 1.1 skrll
4578 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4579 1.13 christos }
4580 1.13 christos
4581 1.13 christos #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4582 1.1 skrll ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4583 1.1 skrll
4584 1.1 skrll /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4585 1.1 skrll
4586 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
4587 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4588 1.1 skrll {
4589 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
4590 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4591 1.1 skrll asection **sections = NULL;
4592 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4593 1.6 christos bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4594 1.5 christos
4595 1.5 christos no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4596 1.5 christos
4597 1.5 christos if (info != NULL)
4598 1.1 skrll info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4599 1.1 skrll
4600 1.1 skrll if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4601 1.1 skrll {
4602 1.1 skrll asection *s;
4603 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4604 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4605 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4606 1.1 skrll asection *last_hdr;
4607 1.1 skrll bfd_vma last_size;
4608 1.1 skrll unsigned int phdr_index;
4609 1.1 skrll bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4610 1.1 skrll asection **hdrpp;
4611 1.9 christos bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4612 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean writable;
4613 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean executable;
4614 1.9 christos int tls_count = 0;
4615 1.1 skrll asection *first_tls = NULL;
4616 1.1 skrll asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4617 1.3 christos asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4618 1.9 christos bfd_size_type amt;
4619 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4620 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4621 1.1 skrll
4622 1.3 christos /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4623 1.9 christos
4624 1.1 skrll sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4625 1.1 skrll sizeof (asection *));
4626 1.1 skrll if (sections == NULL)
4627 1.3 christos goto error_return;
4628 1.3 christos
4629 1.3 christos /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4630 1.3 christos left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4631 1.3 christos being shifted. */
4632 1.3 christos addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4633 1.1 skrll addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4634 1.1 skrll
4635 1.1 skrll i = 0;
4636 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4637 1.1 skrll {
4638 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4639 1.1 skrll {
4640 1.3 christos sections[i] = s;
4641 1.3 christos ++i;
4642 1.3 christos /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4643 1.1 skrll if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4644 1.1 skrll wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4645 1.1 skrll }
4646 1.1 skrll }
4647 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4648 1.1 skrll count = i;
4649 1.1 skrll
4650 1.1 skrll qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4651 1.1 skrll
4652 1.1 skrll /* Build the mapping. */
4653 1.1 skrll
4654 1.1 skrll mfirst = NULL;
4655 1.1 skrll pm = &mfirst;
4656 1.1 skrll
4657 1.1 skrll /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4658 1.1 skrll the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4659 1.12 joerg section. */
4660 1.12 joerg s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4661 1.12 joerg if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4662 1.12 joerg s = NULL;
4663 1.12 joerg dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4664 1.12 joerg if (dynsec != NULL && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4665 1.12 joerg dynsec = NULL;
4666 1.1 skrll
4667 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL || dynsec != NULL)
4668 1.3 christos {
4669 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4670 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4671 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4672 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4673 1.9 christos m->next = NULL;
4674 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4675 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = PF_R;
4676 1.9 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4677 1.1 skrll m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4678 1.1 skrll linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4679 1.12 joerg *pm = m;
4680 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4681 1.12 joerg }
4682 1.12 joerg
4683 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
4684 1.3 christos {
4685 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4686 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4687 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4688 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4689 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4690 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4691 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
4692 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = s;
4693 1.1 skrll
4694 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4695 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4696 1.1 skrll }
4697 1.1 skrll
4698 1.1 skrll /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4699 1.1 skrll segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4700 1.1 skrll a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4701 1.1 skrll last_hdr = NULL;
4702 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
4703 1.6 christos phdr_index = 0;
4704 1.6 christos maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4705 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4706 1.6 christos Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4707 1.6 christos FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4708 1.1 skrll if (maxpagesize == 0)
4709 1.9 christos maxpagesize = 1;
4710 1.1 skrll writable = FALSE;
4711 1.1 skrll executable = FALSE;
4712 1.1 skrll
4713 1.1 skrll /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4714 1.1 skrll is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4715 1.1 skrll approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4716 1.1 skrll program headers we will need. */
4717 1.6 christos if (count > 0)
4718 1.1 skrll {
4719 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4720 1.1 skrll
4721 1.5 christos if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4722 1.1 skrll phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4723 1.3 christos phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4724 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4725 1.3 christos || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4726 1.3 christos || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4727 1.9 christos < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4728 1.9 christos || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4729 1.9 christos {
4730 1.9 christos /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4731 1.9 christos present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4732 1.9 christos program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4733 1.9 christos If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4734 1.9 christos not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4735 1.9 christos force the inclusion if we can... */
4736 1.9 christos if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4737 1.9 christos && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4738 1.9 christos phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4739 1.9 christos else
4740 1.1 skrll phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4741 1.1 skrll }
4742 1.1 skrll }
4743 1.1 skrll
4744 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4745 1.1 skrll {
4746 1.1 skrll asection *hdr;
4747 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean new_segment;
4748 1.1 skrll
4749 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
4750 1.1 skrll
4751 1.1 skrll /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4752 1.1 skrll segment. */
4753 1.1 skrll
4754 1.1 skrll if (last_hdr == NULL)
4755 1.1 skrll {
4756 1.1 skrll /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4757 1.1 skrll one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4758 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
4759 1.1 skrll }
4760 1.1 skrll else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4761 1.1 skrll {
4762 1.1 skrll /* If this section has a different relation between the
4763 1.1 skrll virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4764 1.1 skrll segment. */
4765 1.3 christos new_segment = TRUE;
4766 1.3 christos }
4767 1.3 christos else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4768 1.3 christos || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4769 1.3 christos {
4770 1.3 christos /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4771 1.3 christos the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4772 1.13 christos new_segment = TRUE;
4773 1.13 christos }
4774 1.13 christos else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4775 1.13 christos && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4776 1.13 christos == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4777 1.13 christos {
4778 1.13 christos /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4779 1.13 christos pages onto the same memory page. */
4780 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
4781 1.1 skrll }
4782 1.1 skrll /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4783 1.1 skrll to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4784 1.1 skrll around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4785 1.13 christos pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4786 1.13 christos section can be included in the current segment. */
4787 1.13 christos else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4788 1.13 christos + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4789 1.1 skrll && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4790 1.1 skrll + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4791 1.1 skrll {
4792 1.1 skrll /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4793 1.1 skrll skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4794 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4795 1.13 christos }
4796 1.6 christos else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4797 1.6 christos && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4798 1.6 christos {
4799 1.6 christos /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4800 1.13 christos nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4801 1.1 skrll as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4802 1.1 skrll Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4803 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4804 1.1 skrll }
4805 1.1 skrll else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4806 1.1 skrll {
4807 1.1 skrll /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4808 1.1 skrll don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4809 1.1 skrll file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4810 1.9 christos new_segment = FALSE;
4811 1.9 christos }
4812 1.9 christos else if (info != NULL
4813 1.9 christos && info->separate_code
4814 1.9 christos && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4815 1.9 christos {
4816 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4817 1.13 christos }
4818 1.1 skrll else if (! writable
4819 1.1 skrll && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4820 1.13 christos {
4821 1.1 skrll /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4822 1.1 skrll segment. */
4823 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4824 1.1 skrll }
4825 1.1 skrll else
4826 1.1 skrll {
4827 1.1 skrll /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4828 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
4829 1.1 skrll }
4830 1.1 skrll
4831 1.1 skrll /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4832 1.1 skrll if (last_hdr != NULL
4833 1.1 skrll && info != NULL
4834 1.1 skrll && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4835 1.1 skrll new_segment
4836 1.1 skrll = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4837 1.1 skrll last_hdr,
4838 1.1 skrll new_segment);
4839 1.1 skrll
4840 1.1 skrll if (! new_segment)
4841 1.1 skrll {
4842 1.9 christos if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4843 1.9 christos writable = TRUE;
4844 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4845 1.1 skrll executable = TRUE;
4846 1.13 christos last_hdr = hdr;
4847 1.1 skrll /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4848 1.1 skrll last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4849 1.1 skrll continue;
4850 1.1 skrll }
4851 1.1 skrll
4852 1.1 skrll /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4853 1.1 skrll header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4854 1.1 skrll
4855 1.1 skrll m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4856 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4857 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4858 1.1 skrll
4859 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4860 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4861 1.1 skrll
4862 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4863 1.1 skrll writable = TRUE;
4864 1.1 skrll else
4865 1.9 christos writable = FALSE;
4866 1.9 christos
4867 1.9 christos if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4868 1.9 christos executable = FALSE;
4869 1.9 christos else
4870 1.1 skrll executable = TRUE;
4871 1.1 skrll
4872 1.13 christos last_hdr = hdr;
4873 1.1 skrll /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4874 1.1 skrll last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4875 1.1 skrll phdr_index = i;
4876 1.1 skrll phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4877 1.3 christos }
4878 1.3 christos
4879 1.3 christos /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4880 1.3 christos for .tbss. */
4881 1.13 christos if (last_hdr != NULL
4882 1.1 skrll && (i - phdr_index != 1
4883 1.1 skrll || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4884 1.1 skrll {
4885 1.1 skrll m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4886 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4887 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4888 1.1 skrll
4889 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4890 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4891 1.1 skrll }
4892 1.1 skrll
4893 1.1 skrll /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4894 1.1 skrll if (dynsec != NULL)
4895 1.1 skrll {
4896 1.1 skrll m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4897 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4898 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4899 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4900 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4901 1.1 skrll }
4902 1.1 skrll
4903 1.1 skrll /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4904 1.1 skrll add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4905 1.1 skrll because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4906 1.1 skrll loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4907 1.1 skrll in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4908 1.1 skrll bogus anyhow. */
4909 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4910 1.1 skrll {
4911 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4912 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4913 1.3 christos {
4914 1.3 christos asection *s2;
4915 1.1 skrll
4916 1.1 skrll count = 1;
4917 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4918 1.1 skrll if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4919 1.1 skrll for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4920 1.1 skrll {
4921 1.1 skrll if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4922 1.3 christos && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4923 1.3 christos && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4924 1.1 skrll && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4925 1.1 skrll == s2->next->lma)
4926 1.1 skrll count++;
4927 1.1 skrll else
4928 1.1 skrll break;
4929 1.3 christos }
4930 1.1 skrll amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4931 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4932 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4933 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4934 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4935 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4936 1.1 skrll m->count = count;
4937 1.1 skrll while (count > 1)
4938 1.1 skrll {
4939 1.1 skrll m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4940 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4941 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4942 1.1 skrll }
4943 1.1 skrll m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4944 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4945 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4946 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4947 1.1 skrll }
4948 1.1 skrll if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4949 1.1 skrll {
4950 1.1 skrll if (! tls_count)
4951 1.1 skrll first_tls = s;
4952 1.9 christos tls_count++;
4953 1.9 christos }
4954 1.9 christos if (first_mbind == NULL
4955 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4956 1.1 skrll first_mbind = s;
4957 1.1 skrll }
4958 1.1 skrll
4959 1.1 skrll /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4960 1.1 skrll if (tls_count > 0)
4961 1.1 skrll {
4962 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4963 1.1 skrll amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4964 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4965 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4966 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4967 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4968 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4969 1.1 skrll m->count = tls_count;
4970 1.1 skrll /* Mandated PF_R. */
4971 1.6 christos m->p_flags = PF_R;
4972 1.3 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4973 1.1 skrll s = first_tls;
4974 1.6 christos for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4975 1.6 christos {
4976 1.6 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4977 1.13 christos {
4978 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler
4979 1.6 christos (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4980 1.6 christos s = first_tls;
4981 1.6 christos i = 0;
4982 1.6 christos while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4983 1.6 christos {
4984 1.13 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4985 1.6 christos {
4986 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
4987 1.6 christos i++;
4988 1.13 christos }
4989 1.6 christos else
4990 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
4991 1.6 christos s = s->next;
4992 1.6 christos }
4993 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4994 1.6 christos goto error_return;
4995 1.6 christos }
4996 1.1 skrll m->sections[i] = s;
4997 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4998 1.1 skrll }
4999 1.1 skrll
5000 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
5001 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
5002 1.9 christos }
5003 1.9 christos
5004 1.9 christos if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5005 1.9 christos for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5006 1.9 christos if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
5007 1.9 christos && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
5008 1.9 christos <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
5009 1.9 christos {
5010 1.9 christos /* Mandated PF_R. */
5011 1.9 christos unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
5012 1.9 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
5013 1.9 christos p_flags |= PF_W;
5014 1.9 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5015 1.9 christos p_flags |= PF_X;
5016 1.9 christos
5017 1.9 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5018 1.9 christos m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5019 1.9 christos if (m == NULL)
5020 1.9 christos goto error_return;
5021 1.9 christos m->next = NULL;
5022 1.9 christos m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5023 1.9 christos + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5024 1.9 christos m->count = 1;
5025 1.9 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5026 1.9 christos m->sections[0] = s;
5027 1.9 christos m->p_flags = p_flags;
5028 1.9 christos
5029 1.9 christos *pm = m;
5030 1.9 christos pm = &m->next;
5031 1.1 skrll }
5032 1.1 skrll
5033 1.6 christos /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5034 1.1 skrll segment. */
5035 1.1 skrll eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5036 1.1 skrll if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5037 1.1 skrll && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5038 1.3 christos {
5039 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5040 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5041 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
5042 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
5043 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
5044 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5045 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
5046 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5047 1.1 skrll
5048 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
5049 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
5050 1.6 christos }
5051 1.1 skrll
5052 1.1 skrll if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5053 1.3 christos {
5054 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5055 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5056 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
5057 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
5058 1.6 christos m->next = NULL;
5059 1.6 christos m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5060 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5061 1.6 christos m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5062 1.6 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5063 1.6 christos m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5064 1.6 christos if (info->stacksize > 0)
5065 1.6 christos {
5066 1.6 christos m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5067 1.1 skrll m->p_size_valid = 1;
5068 1.1 skrll }
5069 1.1 skrll
5070 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
5071 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
5072 1.1 skrll }
5073 1.1 skrll
5074 1.1 skrll if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5075 1.1 skrll {
5076 1.5 christos for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5077 1.5 christos {
5078 1.5 christos if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5079 1.5 christos && m->count != 0
5080 1.5 christos && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5081 1.5 christos && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5082 1.5 christos {
5083 1.5 christos i = m->count;
5084 1.5 christos while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5085 1.5 christos if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5086 1.5 christos == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5087 1.6 christos break;
5088 1.1 skrll
5089 1.1 skrll if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5090 1.5 christos break;
5091 1.1 skrll }
5092 1.1 skrll }
5093 1.1 skrll
5094 1.1 skrll /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5095 1.1 skrll if (m != NULL)
5096 1.3 christos {
5097 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5098 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5099 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
5100 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
5101 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
5102 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5103 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
5104 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
5105 1.1 skrll }
5106 1.1 skrll }
5107 1.6 christos
5108 1.1 skrll free (sections);
5109 1.1 skrll elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5110 1.1 skrll }
5111 1.1 skrll
5112 1.1 skrll if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5113 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5114 1.1 skrll
5115 1.6 christos for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5116 1.1 skrll ++count;
5117 1.1 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5118 1.1 skrll
5119 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5120 1.1 skrll
5121 1.1 skrll error_return:
5122 1.1 skrll if (sections != NULL)
5123 1.1 skrll free (sections);
5124 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5125 1.1 skrll }
5126 1.1 skrll
5127 1.1 skrll /* Sort sections by address. */
5128 1.1 skrll
5129 1.1 skrll static int
5130 1.1 skrll elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5131 1.1 skrll {
5132 1.1 skrll const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5133 1.1 skrll const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5134 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5135 1.1 skrll
5136 1.1 skrll /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5137 1.1 skrll place the section into a segment. */
5138 1.1 skrll if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5139 1.1 skrll return -1;
5140 1.1 skrll else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5141 1.1 skrll return 1;
5142 1.1 skrll
5143 1.1 skrll /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5144 1.1 skrll the same, and this will do nothing. */
5145 1.1 skrll if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5146 1.1 skrll return -1;
5147 1.1 skrll else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5148 1.1 skrll return 1;
5149 1.1 skrll
5150 1.1 skrll /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5151 1.1 skrll
5152 1.1 skrll #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5153 1.1 skrll
5154 1.1 skrll if (TOEND (sec1))
5155 1.1 skrll {
5156 1.1 skrll if (TOEND (sec2))
5157 1.1 skrll {
5158 1.1 skrll /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
5159 1.1 skrll here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5160 1.1 skrll if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5161 1.1 skrll return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5162 1.1 skrll }
5163 1.1 skrll else
5164 1.1 skrll return 1;
5165 1.1 skrll }
5166 1.1 skrll else if (TOEND (sec2))
5167 1.1 skrll return -1;
5168 1.1 skrll
5169 1.1 skrll #undef TOEND
5170 1.1 skrll
5171 1.1 skrll /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5172 1.1 skrll before others at the same address. */
5173 1.1 skrll
5174 1.1 skrll size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5175 1.1 skrll size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5176 1.1 skrll
5177 1.1 skrll if (size1 < size2)
5178 1.1 skrll return -1;
5179 1.1 skrll if (size1 > size2)
5180 1.1 skrll return 1;
5181 1.1 skrll
5182 1.1 skrll return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5183 1.1 skrll }
5184 1.1 skrll
5185 1.1 skrll /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5186 1.1 skrll
5187 1.1 skrll We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5188 1.1 skrll not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5189 1.1 skrll negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5190 1.1 skrll are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5191 1.1 skrll larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5192 1.1 skrll which is wrong.
5193 1.1 skrll
5194 1.1 skrll What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5195 1.1 skrll the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5196 1.1 skrll the page size.'' */
5197 1.1 skrll /* In other words, something like:
5198 1.1 skrll
5199 1.1 skrll vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5200 1.1 skrll off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5201 1.1 skrll if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5202 1.1 skrll adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5203 1.1 skrll else
5204 1.9 christos adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5205 1.1 skrll
5206 1.1 skrll which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5207 1.1 skrll
5208 1.1 skrll static file_ptr
5209 1.6 christos vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5210 1.6 christos {
5211 1.6 christos /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5212 1.1 skrll if (maxpagesize == 0)
5213 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = 1;
5214 1.1 skrll return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5215 1.1 skrll }
5216 1.1 skrll
5217 1.1 skrll static void
5218 1.1 skrll print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5219 1.1 skrll {
5220 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
5221 1.1 skrll const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5222 1.1 skrll char buf[32];
5223 1.1 skrll
5224 1.1 skrll if (pt == NULL)
5225 1.1 skrll {
5226 1.1 skrll if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5227 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5228 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5229 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5230 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5231 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5232 1.1 skrll else
5233 1.1 skrll snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5234 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5235 1.3 christos pt = buf;
5236 1.1 skrll }
5237 1.1 skrll fflush (stdout);
5238 1.1 skrll fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5239 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5240 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5241 1.3 christos putc ('\n',stderr);
5242 1.3 christos fflush (stderr);
5243 1.3 christos }
5244 1.3 christos
5245 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
5246 1.3 christos write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5247 1.3 christos {
5248 1.3 christos void *buf;
5249 1.3 christos bfd_boolean ret;
5250 1.3 christos
5251 1.3 christos if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5252 1.3 christos return FALSE;
5253 1.3 christos buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5254 1.3 christos if (buf == NULL)
5255 1.3 christos return FALSE;
5256 1.3 christos ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5257 1.1 skrll free (buf);
5258 1.1 skrll return ret;
5259 1.1 skrll }
5260 1.1 skrll
5261 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5262 1.1 skrll sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5263 1.1 skrll the file header. */
5264 1.1 skrll
5265 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5266 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5267 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5268 1.1 skrll {
5269 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5270 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
5271 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5272 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5273 1.9 christos file_ptr off;
5274 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5275 1.1 skrll unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5276 1.2 skrll unsigned int alloc;
5277 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, j;
5278 1.1 skrll bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5279 1.1 skrll
5280 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL
5281 1.1 skrll && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5282 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5283 1.6 christos
5284 1.2 skrll alloc = 0;
5285 1.2 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5286 1.2 skrll {
5287 1.2 skrll ++alloc;
5288 1.2 skrll if (m->header_size)
5289 1.1 skrll header_pad = m->header_size;
5290 1.5 christos }
5291 1.5 christos
5292 1.5 christos if (alloc)
5293 1.5 christos {
5294 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5295 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5296 1.5 christos }
5297 1.5 christos else
5298 1.5 christos {
5299 1.5 christos /* PR binutils/12467. */
5300 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5301 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5302 1.1 skrll }
5303 1.1 skrll
5304 1.6 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5305 1.6 christos
5306 1.1 skrll if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5307 1.6 christos elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5308 1.1 skrll else
5309 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5310 1.1 skrll >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5311 1.1 skrll
5312 1.6 christos if (alloc == 0)
5313 1.1 skrll {
5314 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5315 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5316 1.6 christos }
5317 1.2 skrll
5318 1.2 skrll /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5319 1.6 christos see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5320 1.6 christos that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5321 1.2 skrll The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5322 1.2 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5323 1.2 skrll layout.
5324 1.2 skrll See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5325 1.6 christos where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5326 1.2 skrll last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5327 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5328 1.3 christos == 0);
5329 1.9 christos phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5330 1.9 christos bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
5331 1.1 skrll (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5332 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5333 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5334 1.1 skrll if (phdrs == NULL)
5335 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5336 1.1 skrll
5337 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = 1;
5338 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5339 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5340 1.1 skrll
5341 1.2 skrll off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5342 1.2 skrll off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5343 1.2 skrll if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5344 1.2 skrll header_pad = 0;
5345 1.2 skrll else
5346 1.1 skrll header_pad -= off;
5347 1.6 christos off += header_pad;
5348 1.1 skrll
5349 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5350 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
5351 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++, j++)
5352 1.1 skrll {
5353 1.1 skrll asection **secpp;
5354 1.1 skrll bfd_vma off_adjust;
5355 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean no_contents;
5356 1.1 skrll
5357 1.1 skrll /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5358 1.1 skrll sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5359 1.1 skrll not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5360 1.1 skrll contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5361 1.1 skrll Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5362 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 1
5363 1.1 skrll && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5364 1.1 skrll && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5365 1.1 skrll qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5366 1.1 skrll elf_sort_sections);
5367 1.1 skrll
5368 1.1 skrll /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5369 1.1 skrll number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5370 1.1 skrll and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5371 1.1 skrll that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5372 1.1 skrll available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5373 1.1 skrll p->p_type = m->p_type;
5374 1.1 skrll p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5375 1.1 skrll
5376 1.1 skrll if (m->count == 0)
5377 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = 0;
5378 1.1 skrll else
5379 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5380 1.1 skrll
5381 1.1 skrll if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5382 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5383 1.1 skrll else if (m->count == 0)
5384 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = 0;
5385 1.1 skrll else
5386 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5387 1.1 skrll
5388 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5389 1.1 skrll && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5390 1.1 skrll {
5391 1.1 skrll /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5392 1.1 skrll the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5393 1.1 skrll objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5394 1.1 skrll value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5395 1.1 skrll may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5396 1.1 skrll segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5397 1.1 skrll on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5398 1.1 skrll segment. */
5399 1.1 skrll if (m->p_align_valid)
5400 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5401 1.9 christos
5402 1.1 skrll p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5403 1.1 skrll pt_load_count += 1;
5404 1.1 skrll }
5405 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_align_valid)
5406 1.1 skrll p->p_align = m->p_align;
5407 1.1 skrll else if (m->count == 0)
5408 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5409 1.1 skrll else
5410 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 0;
5411 1.1 skrll
5412 1.1 skrll no_contents = FALSE;
5413 1.1 skrll off_adjust = 0;
5414 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5415 1.1 skrll && m->count > 0)
5416 1.1 skrll {
5417 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type align;
5418 1.1 skrll unsigned int align_power = 0;
5419 1.1 skrll
5420 1.1 skrll if (m->p_align_valid)
5421 1.1 skrll align = p->p_align;
5422 1.1 skrll else
5423 1.1 skrll {
5424 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5425 1.1 skrll {
5426 1.1 skrll unsigned int secalign;
5427 1.1 skrll
5428 1.1 skrll secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5429 1.1 skrll if (secalign > align_power)
5430 1.1 skrll align_power = secalign;
5431 1.1 skrll }
5432 1.1 skrll align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5433 1.1 skrll if (align < maxpagesize)
5434 1.1 skrll align = maxpagesize;
5435 1.1 skrll }
5436 1.1 skrll
5437 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5438 1.1 skrll if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5439 1.1 skrll /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5440 1.1 skrll it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5441 1.1 skrll set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5442 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5443 1.1 skrll
5444 1.1 skrll /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5445 1.1 skrll sections. */
5446 1.1 skrll no_contents = TRUE;
5447 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5448 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5449 1.1 skrll {
5450 1.1 skrll no_contents = FALSE;
5451 1.1 skrll break;
5452 1.3 christos }
5453 1.9 christos
5454 1.9 christos off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5455 1.9 christos
5456 1.9 christos /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5457 1.9 christos map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5458 1.9 christos processors. */
5459 1.9 christos if (pt_load_count > 1
5460 1.9 christos && bed->no_page_alias
5461 1.9 christos && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5462 1.1 skrll && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5463 1.1 skrll off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5464 1.1 skrll off += off_adjust;
5465 1.1 skrll if (no_contents)
5466 1.1 skrll {
5467 1.1 skrll /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5468 1.1 skrll the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5469 1.1 skrll arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5470 1.1 skrll checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5471 1.1 skrll requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5472 1.1 skrll p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5473 1.1 skrll subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5474 1.1 skrll past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5475 1.1 skrll }
5476 1.1 skrll else
5477 1.1 skrll off_adjust = 0;
5478 1.1 skrll }
5479 1.1 skrll /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5480 1.1 skrll PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5481 1.1 skrll else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5482 1.1 skrll && m->count > 1
5483 1.1 skrll && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5484 1.13 christos {
5485 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
5486 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5487 1.1 skrll " is not the .dynamic section"),
5488 1.1 skrll abfd);
5489 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5490 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5491 1.1 skrll }
5492 1.1 skrll /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5493 1.1 skrll else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5494 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5495 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5496 1.1 skrll
5497 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = 0;
5498 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = 0;
5499 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = 0;
5500 1.1 skrll
5501 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
5502 1.1 skrll {
5503 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5504 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5505 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5506 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5507 1.9 christos if (m->count > 0)
5508 1.9 christos {
5509 1.9 christos if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5510 1.1 skrll || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5511 1.9 christos && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5512 1.13 christos {
5513 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
5514 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5515 1.1 skrll " try linking with -N"),
5516 1.1 skrll abfd);
5517 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5518 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5519 1.1 skrll }
5520 1.1 skrll
5521 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr -= off;
5522 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5523 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr -= off;
5524 1.1 skrll }
5525 1.1 skrll }
5526 1.1 skrll
5527 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_phdrs)
5528 1.1 skrll {
5529 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5530 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5531 1.1 skrll
5532 1.1 skrll if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5533 1.1 skrll {
5534 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5535 1.1 skrll
5536 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 0)
5537 1.1 skrll {
5538 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5539 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5540 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5541 1.1 skrll }
5542 1.1 skrll }
5543 1.1 skrll
5544 1.2 skrll p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5545 1.2 skrll p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5546 1.2 skrll if (m->count)
5547 1.2 skrll {
5548 1.2 skrll p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5549 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5550 1.1 skrll }
5551 1.1 skrll }
5552 1.1 skrll
5553 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5554 1.1 skrll || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5555 1.1 skrll {
5556 1.1 skrll if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5557 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = off;
5558 1.1 skrll else
5559 1.1 skrll {
5560 1.1 skrll file_ptr adjust;
5561 1.1 skrll
5562 1.1 skrll adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5563 1.1 skrll if (!no_contents)
5564 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += adjust;
5565 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += adjust;
5566 1.1 skrll }
5567 1.1 skrll }
5568 1.1 skrll
5569 1.1 skrll /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5570 1.1 skrll maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5571 1.1 skrll core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5572 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5573 1.1 skrll for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5574 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5575 1.1 skrll {
5576 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
5577 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type align;
5578 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5579 1.1 skrll
5580 1.1 skrll sec = *secpp;
5581 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5582 1.1 skrll align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5583 1.1 skrll
5584 1.1 skrll if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5585 1.1 skrll || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5586 1.1 skrll && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5587 1.1 skrll || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5588 1.1 skrll && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5589 1.3 christos || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5590 1.3 christos {
5591 1.3 christos bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5592 1.3 christos bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5593 1.3 christos bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5594 1.3 christos bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5595 1.3 christos
5596 1.3 christos if (adjust != 0
5597 1.1 skrll && (s_start < p_end
5598 1.9 christos || p_end < p_start))
5599 1.9 christos {
5600 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
5601 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
5602 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5603 1.3 christos abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start, (uint64_t) p_end);
5604 1.1 skrll adjust = 0;
5605 1.1 skrll sec->lma = p_end;
5606 1.1 skrll }
5607 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += adjust;
5608 1.1 skrll
5609 1.3 christos if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5610 1.3 christos {
5611 1.3 christos if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5612 1.9 christos {
5613 1.3 christos /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5614 1.3 christos Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5615 1.3 christos zero it. */
5616 1.3 christos adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5617 1.3 christos if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5618 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5619 1.1 skrll }
5620 1.1 skrll off += adjust;
5621 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += adjust;
5622 1.1 skrll }
5623 1.1 skrll }
5624 1.1 skrll
5625 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5626 1.1 skrll {
5627 1.1 skrll /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5628 1.1 skrll everything. */
5629 1.1 skrll if (i == 0)
5630 1.1 skrll {
5631 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5632 1.1 skrll off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5633 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5634 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = 0;
5635 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1;
5636 1.1 skrll }
5637 1.1 skrll else
5638 1.1 skrll {
5639 1.1 skrll /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5640 1.1 skrll sec->filepos = 0;
5641 1.1 skrll sec->size = 0;
5642 1.1 skrll sec->flags = 0;
5643 1.1 skrll continue;
5644 1.1 skrll }
5645 1.1 skrll }
5646 1.1 skrll else
5647 1.1 skrll {
5648 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5649 1.1 skrll {
5650 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5651 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5652 1.3 christos off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5653 1.3 christos }
5654 1.3 christos else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5655 1.3 christos && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5656 1.3 christos && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5657 1.3 christos {
5658 1.3 christos /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5659 1.3 christos (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5660 1.3 christos final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5661 1.3 christos would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5662 1.3 christos p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5663 1.3 christos also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5664 1.3 christos p_offset value. */
5665 1.3 christos bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5666 1.3 christos off, align);
5667 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5668 1.1 skrll }
5669 1.1 skrll
5670 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5671 1.1 skrll {
5672 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5673 1.1 skrll /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5674 1.1 skrll a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5675 1.1 skrll file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5676 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5677 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5678 1.1 skrll }
5679 1.1 skrll else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5680 1.1 skrll {
5681 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5682 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5683 1.1 skrll
5684 1.1 skrll /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5685 1.1 skrll normal segments. */
5686 1.1 skrll else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5687 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5688 1.1 skrll }
5689 1.1 skrll
5690 1.1 skrll if (align > p->p_align
5691 1.1 skrll && !m->p_align_valid
5692 1.1 skrll && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5693 1.1 skrll || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5694 1.1 skrll p->p_align = align;
5695 1.1 skrll }
5696 1.1 skrll
5697 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5698 1.1 skrll {
5699 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5700 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5701 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5702 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5703 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5704 1.6 christos }
5705 1.1 skrll }
5706 1.1 skrll
5707 1.1 skrll off -= off_adjust;
5708 1.1 skrll
5709 1.1 skrll /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5710 1.3 christos Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5711 1.3 christos if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5712 1.1 skrll {
5713 1.3 christos bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5714 1.3 christos
5715 1.3 christos for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5716 1.3 christos if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5717 1.3 christos && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5718 1.3 christos ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5719 1.1 skrll && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5720 1.3 christos ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5721 1.3 christos {
5722 1.3 christos /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5723 1.1 skrll check_vma = FALSE;
5724 1.3 christos break;
5725 1.3 christos }
5726 1.3 christos
5727 1.3 christos for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5728 1.3 christos {
5729 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5730 1.3 christos asection *sec;
5731 1.3 christos
5732 1.3 christos sec = m->sections[i];
5733 1.3 christos this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5734 1.3 christos if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5735 1.9 christos && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5736 1.9 christos {
5737 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
5738 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
5739 1.3 christos (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5740 1.3 christos abfd, sec, j);
5741 1.3 christos print_segment_map (m);
5742 1.3 christos }
5743 1.1 skrll }
5744 1.1 skrll }
5745 1.6 christos }
5746 1.1 skrll
5747 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5748 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5749 1.1 skrll }
5750 1.1 skrll
5751 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5752 1.1 skrll
5753 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5754 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5755 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5756 1.1 skrll {
5757 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5758 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5759 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5760 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5761 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5762 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
5763 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5764 1.1 skrll bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5765 1.1 skrll bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5766 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
5767 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
5768 1.6 christos
5769 1.6 christos i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5770 1.6 christos end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5771 1.1 skrll off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5772 1.1 skrll for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5773 1.1 skrll {
5774 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5775 1.1 skrll
5776 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
5777 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5778 1.1 skrll && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5779 1.1 skrll || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5780 1.1 skrll && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5781 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5782 1.5 christos else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5783 1.9 christos {
5784 1.9 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5785 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
5786 1.5 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
5787 1.5 christos (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5788 1.5 christos abfd,
5789 1.5 christos (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5790 1.1 skrll ? "*unknown*"
5791 1.1 skrll : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5792 1.1 skrll /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5793 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5794 1.1 skrll off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5795 1.1 skrll bed->maxpagesize);
5796 1.1 skrll else
5797 1.1 skrll off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5798 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_addralign);
5799 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5800 1.1 skrll FALSE);
5801 1.1 skrll }
5802 1.6 christos else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5803 1.6 christos && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5804 1.6 christos || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5805 1.6 christos && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5806 1.6 christos /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5807 1.6 christos || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5808 1.6 christos || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5809 1.6 christos && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5810 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5811 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5812 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5813 1.1 skrll else
5814 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5815 1.1 skrll }
5816 1.1 skrll
5817 1.1 skrll /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5818 1.1 skrll the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5819 1.1 skrll count = 0;
5820 1.1 skrll filehdr_vaddr = 0;
5821 1.1 skrll filehdr_paddr = 0;
5822 1.5 christos phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5823 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr = 0;
5824 1.6 christos hdrs_segment = NULL;
5825 1.1 skrll phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5826 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5827 1.1 skrll {
5828 1.1 skrll ++count;
5829 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5830 1.1 skrll continue;
5831 1.1 skrll
5832 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
5833 1.1 skrll {
5834 1.1 skrll filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5835 1.1 skrll filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5836 1.1 skrll }
5837 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_phdrs)
5838 1.1 skrll {
5839 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5840 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5841 1.5 christos if (m->includes_filehdr)
5842 1.1 skrll {
5843 1.1 skrll hdrs_segment = m;
5844 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5845 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5846 1.1 skrll }
5847 1.1 skrll }
5848 1.5 christos }
5849 1.5 christos
5850 1.5 christos if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5851 1.5 christos {
5852 1.5 christos /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5853 1.5 christos program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5854 1.5 christos A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5855 1.5 christos
5856 1.5 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5857 1.5 christos = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5858 1.5 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5859 1.5 christos /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5860 1.5 christos if (hash != NULL
5861 1.5 christos && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5862 1.5 christos || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5863 1.5 christos || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5864 1.5 christos || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5865 1.5 christos {
5866 1.5 christos asection *s = NULL;
5867 1.5 christos if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5868 1.5 christos /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5869 1.5 christos s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5870 1.6 christos else
5871 1.5 christos /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5872 1.5 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5873 1.5 christos if (m->count != 0)
5874 1.5 christos {
5875 1.5 christos s = m->sections[0];
5876 1.5 christos break;
5877 1.5 christos }
5878 1.5 christos
5879 1.5 christos if (s != NULL)
5880 1.5 christos {
5881 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5882 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5883 1.5 christos }
5884 1.5 christos else
5885 1.5 christos {
5886 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5887 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5888 1.5 christos }
5889 1.5 christos
5890 1.5 christos hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5891 1.5 christos hash->def_regular = 1;
5892 1.5 christos hash->non_elf = 0;
5893 1.5 christos }
5894 1.6 christos }
5895 1.1 skrll
5896 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5897 1.1 skrll {
5898 1.13 christos if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5899 1.13 christos {
5900 1.1 skrll bfd_vma start, end;
5901 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean ok;
5902 1.1 skrll
5903 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
5904 1.13 christos {
5905 1.13 christos /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5906 1.13 christos in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
5907 1.13 christos relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
5908 1.13 christos start = link_info->relro_start;
5909 1.13 christos end = link_info->relro_end;
5910 1.13 christos }
5911 1.13 christos else if (m->count != 0)
5912 1.13 christos {
5913 1.13 christos if (!m->p_size_valid)
5914 1.13 christos abort ();
5915 1.13 christos start = m->sections[0]->vma;
5916 1.13 christos end = start + m->p_size;
5917 1.13 christos }
5918 1.13 christos else
5919 1.13 christos {
5920 1.13 christos start = 0;
5921 1.13 christos end = 0;
5922 1.13 christos }
5923 1.13 christos
5924 1.13 christos ok = FALSE;
5925 1.13 christos if (start < end)
5926 1.13 christos {
5927 1.13 christos struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5928 1.13 christos const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5929 1.13 christos unsigned int i;
5930 1.13 christos
5931 1.6 christos /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
5932 1.5 christos segment. */
5933 1.5 christos for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5934 1.1 skrll lm != NULL;
5935 1.1 skrll lm = lm->next, lp++)
5936 1.5 christos {
5937 1.13 christos if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5938 1.13 christos && lm->count != 0
5939 1.13 christos && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
5940 1.13 christos + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
5941 1.13 christos ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size
5942 1.1 skrll : 0)) > start
5943 1.1 skrll && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
5944 1.5 christos break;
5945 1.13 christos }
5946 1.1 skrll
5947 1.13 christos if (lm != NULL)
5948 1.13 christos {
5949 1.13 christos /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
5950 1.13 christos for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
5951 1.13 christos {
5952 1.13 christos asection *s = lm->sections[i];
5953 1.13 christos if (s->vma >= start
5954 1.13 christos && s->vma < end
5955 1.13 christos && s->size != 0)
5956 1.13 christos break;
5957 1.13 christos }
5958 1.13 christos
5959 1.13 christos if (i < lm->count)
5960 1.13 christos {
5961 1.13 christos p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma;
5962 1.13 christos p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma;
5963 1.13 christos p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
5964 1.13 christos p->p_memsz = end - p->p_vaddr;
5965 1.13 christos p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
5966 1.13 christos
5967 1.13 christos /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
5968 1.13 christos into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
5969 1.13 christos In cases where the end does not match any
5970 1.13 christos loaded section (for instance is in file
5971 1.13 christos padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
5972 1.13 christos the end of loaded section contents. */
5973 1.13 christos if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
5974 1.13 christos p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
5975 1.13 christos
5976 1.13 christos /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
5977 1.13 christos valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
5978 1.13 christos the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
5979 1.13 christos objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5980 1.13 christos otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
5981 1.13 christos debug files. */
5982 1.13 christos if (!m->p_align_valid)
5983 1.13 christos p->p_align = 1;
5984 1.13 christos if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5985 1.13 christos p->p_flags = PF_R;
5986 1.1 skrll ok = TRUE;
5987 1.1 skrll }
5988 1.13 christos }
5989 1.13 christos }
5990 1.13 christos if (link_info != NULL)
5991 1.13 christos BFD_ASSERT (ok);
5992 1.1 skrll if (!ok)
5993 1.6 christos memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5994 1.6 christos }
5995 1.6 christos else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5996 1.6 christos {
5997 1.6 christos if (m->p_size_valid)
5998 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5999 1.1 skrll }
6000 1.6 christos else if (m->count != 0)
6001 1.9 christos {
6002 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6003 1.1 skrll
6004 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
6005 1.1 skrll && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
6006 1.9 christos || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
6007 1.9 christos {
6008 1.9 christos /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6009 1.9 christos segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6010 1.9 christos if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6011 1.9 christos {
6012 1.9 christos m->count = 0;
6013 1.9 christos continue;
6014 1.6 christos }
6015 1.6 christos
6016 1.6 christos if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6017 1.9 christos {
6018 1.13 christos /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6019 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
6020 1.9 christos (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6021 1.6 christos "and/or program header"),
6022 1.6 christos abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6023 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6024 1.3 christos }
6025 1.1 skrll
6026 1.3 christos p->p_filesz = 0;
6027 1.3 christos p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6028 1.3 christos for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6029 1.3 christos {
6030 1.3 christos asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6031 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6032 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6033 1.3 christos {
6034 1.3 christos p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6035 1.3 christos + hdr->sh_size);
6036 1.3 christos break;
6037 1.1 skrll }
6038 1.1 skrll }
6039 1.1 skrll }
6040 1.1 skrll }
6041 1.1 skrll else if (m->includes_filehdr)
6042 1.1 skrll {
6043 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
6044 1.1 skrll if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6045 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
6046 1.1 skrll }
6047 1.1 skrll else if (m->includes_phdrs)
6048 1.1 skrll {
6049 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
6050 1.1 skrll if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6051 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
6052 1.1 skrll }
6053 1.6 christos }
6054 1.1 skrll
6055 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6056 1.1 skrll
6057 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6058 1.6 christos }
6059 1.6 christos
6060 1.6 christos static elf_section_list *
6061 1.6 christos find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6062 1.6 christos {
6063 1.6 christos for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6064 1.6 christos if (list->ndx == i)
6065 1.6 christos break;
6066 1.6 christos return list;
6067 1.1 skrll }
6068 1.1 skrll
6069 1.1 skrll /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6070 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6071 1.1 skrll VMAs must be known before this is called.
6072 1.1 skrll
6073 1.1 skrll Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6074 1.1 skrll "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
6075 1.1 skrll those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
6076 1.1 skrll stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
6077 1.1 skrll consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
6078 1.1 skrll image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
6079 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6080 1.1 skrll
6081 1.1 skrll We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6082 1.1 skrll
6083 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6084 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6085 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6086 1.1 skrll {
6087 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6088 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6089 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6090 1.1 skrll
6091 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6092 1.1 skrll && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6093 1.1 skrll {
6094 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6095 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6096 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6097 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6098 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
6099 1.1 skrll
6100 1.1 skrll /* Start after the ELF header. */
6101 1.1 skrll off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6102 1.1 skrll
6103 1.1 skrll /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6104 1.1 skrll not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6105 1.1 skrll the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6106 1.1 skrll for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6107 1.1 skrll {
6108 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6109 1.1 skrll
6110 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
6111 1.6 christos if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6112 1.6 christos && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6113 1.6 christos || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6114 1.6 christos && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6115 1.6 christos /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6116 1.6 christos || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6117 1.6 christos || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6118 1.6 christos && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6119 1.1 skrll || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6120 1.1 skrll || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6121 1.1 skrll {
6122 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6123 1.1 skrll }
6124 1.1 skrll else
6125 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6126 1.6 christos }
6127 1.1 skrll
6128 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6129 1.1 skrll }
6130 1.1 skrll else
6131 1.1 skrll {
6132 1.1 skrll unsigned int alloc;
6133 1.1 skrll
6134 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6135 1.1 skrll assignment of sections to segments. */
6136 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6137 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6138 1.1 skrll
6139 1.1 skrll /* And for non-load sections. */
6140 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6141 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6142 1.1 skrll
6143 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6144 1.1 skrll {
6145 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6146 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6147 1.6 christos }
6148 1.6 christos
6149 1.6 christos /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6150 1.6 christos if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6151 1.6 christos {
6152 1.6 christos unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6153 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6154 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6155 1.6 christos
6156 1.6 christos /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6157 1.6 christos bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6158 1.6 christos for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6159 1.6 christos if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6160 1.6 christos p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6161 1.6 christos
6162 1.6 christos /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6163 1.6 christos segments is non-zero. */
6164 1.6 christos if (p_vaddr)
6165 1.6 christos i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6166 1.1 skrll }
6167 1.13 christos
6168 1.9 christos /* Write out the program headers. */
6169 1.9 christos alloc = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6170 1.9 christos if (alloc == 0)
6171 1.9 christos return TRUE;
6172 1.9 christos
6173 1.9 christos /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6174 1.9 christos be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6175 1.9 christos really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6176 1.9 christos message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6177 1.9 christos in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6178 1.9 christos catch all real world use cases.
6179 1.9 christos
6180 1.9 christos FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6181 1.9 christos ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6182 1.9 christos including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6183 1.9 christos changed or the programs updated. */
6184 1.13 christos if (alloc > 1
6185 1.13 christos && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6186 1.13 christos && (bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr == NULL
6187 1.9 christos || !bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr,
6188 1.9 christos alloc))
6189 1.13 christos && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6190 1.13 christos && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6191 1.9 christos || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz
6192 1.9 christos < tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6193 1.9 christos {
6194 1.9 christos /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6195 1.13 christos used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6196 1.13 christos leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6197 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
6198 1.9 christos " by LOAD segment"),
6199 1.9 christos abfd);
6200 1.9 christos return FALSE;
6201 1.1 skrll }
6202 1.1 skrll
6203 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6204 1.1 skrll || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6205 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6206 1.1 skrll }
6207 1.1 skrll
6208 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6209 1.1 skrll }
6210 1.1 skrll
6211 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6212 1.3 christos prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6213 1.1 skrll {
6214 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6215 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6216 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6217 1.1 skrll
6218 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6219 1.1 skrll
6220 1.1 skrll shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6221 1.1 skrll if (shstrtab == NULL)
6222 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6223 1.1 skrll
6224 1.1 skrll elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6225 1.1 skrll
6226 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6227 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6228 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6229 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6230 1.1 skrll
6231 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6232 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6233 1.1 skrll bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6234 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6235 1.1 skrll
6236 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6237 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6238 1.1 skrll else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6239 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6240 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6241 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6242 1.1 skrll else
6243 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6244 1.1 skrll
6245 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6246 1.1 skrll {
6247 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_unknown:
6248 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6249 1.1 skrll break;
6250 1.1 skrll
6251 1.1 skrll /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6252 1.1 skrll e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6253 1.1 skrll in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6254 1.1 skrll the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6255 1.1 skrll can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6256 1.1 skrll unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6257 1.1 skrll Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6258 1.1 skrll e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6259 1.1 skrll default:
6260 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6261 1.1 skrll }
6262 1.1 skrll
6263 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6264 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6265 1.1 skrll
6266 1.1 skrll /* No program header, for now. */
6267 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6268 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6269 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6270 1.1 skrll
6271 1.1 skrll /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6272 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6273 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6274 1.1 skrll
6275 1.1 skrll /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6276 1.1 skrll if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6277 1.1 skrll /* It all happens later. */
6278 1.1 skrll ;
6279 1.1 skrll else
6280 1.1 skrll {
6281 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6282 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6283 1.1 skrll }
6284 1.1 skrll
6285 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6286 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6287 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6288 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6289 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6290 1.6 christos (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6291 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6292 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6293 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6294 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6295 1.1 skrll
6296 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6297 1.1 skrll }
6298 1.6 christos
6299 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6300 1.6 christos of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6301 1.6 christos
6302 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6303 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6304 1.6 christos {
6305 1.6 christos file_ptr off;
6306 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6307 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6308 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6309 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6310 1.1 skrll
6311 1.6 christos off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6312 1.6 christos
6313 1.6 christos shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6314 1.1 skrll end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6315 1.6 christos for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6316 1.6 christos {
6317 1.6 christos shdrp = *shdrpp;
6318 1.6 christos if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6319 1.6 christos {
6320 1.6 christos asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6321 1.6 christos bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6322 1.6 christos || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6323 1.6 christos if (is_rel
6324 1.6 christos || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6325 1.6 christos {
6326 1.6 christos if (!is_rel)
6327 1.6 christos {
6328 1.6 christos const char *name = sec->name;
6329 1.6 christos struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6330 1.6 christos
6331 1.6 christos /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6332 1.6 christos if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6333 1.1 skrll shdrp->contents))
6334 1.6 christos return FALSE;
6335 1.6 christos
6336 1.6 christos if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6337 1.6 christos && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6338 1.6 christos {
6339 1.6 christos /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6340 1.6 christos section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6341 1.6 christos char *new_name
6342 1.6 christos = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6343 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
6344 1.6 christos return FALSE;
6345 1.9 christos name = new_name;
6346 1.6 christos }
6347 1.6 christos /* Add section name to section name section. */
6348 1.6 christos if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6349 1.6 christos abort ();
6350 1.6 christos shdrp->sh_name
6351 1.6 christos = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6352 1.6 christos name, FALSE);
6353 1.9 christos d = elf_section_data (sec);
6354 1.6 christos
6355 1.6 christos /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6356 1.6 christos if (d->rel.hdr
6357 1.6 christos && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6358 1.6 christos d->rel.hdr,
6359 1.6 christos name, FALSE))
6360 1.6 christos return FALSE;
6361 1.6 christos if (d->rela.hdr
6362 1.6 christos && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6363 1.6 christos d->rela.hdr,
6364 1.6 christos name, TRUE))
6365 1.6 christos return FALSE;
6366 1.6 christos
6367 1.6 christos /* Update section size and contents. */
6368 1.6 christos shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6369 1.6 christos shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6370 1.6 christos shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6371 1.6 christos }
6372 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6373 1.6 christos off,
6374 1.6 christos TRUE);
6375 1.1 skrll }
6376 1.1 skrll }
6377 1.6 christos }
6378 1.6 christos
6379 1.6 christos /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6380 1.6 christos compressed. */
6381 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6382 1.6 christos shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6383 1.6 christos shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6384 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6385 1.6 christos
6386 1.6 christos /* Place the section headers. */
6387 1.6 christos i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6388 1.6 christos bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6389 1.6 christos off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6390 1.6 christos i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6391 1.6 christos off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6392 1.6 christos elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6393 1.1 skrll
6394 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6395 1.1 skrll }
6396 1.1 skrll
6397 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6398 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6399 1.1 skrll {
6400 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6401 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6402 1.6 christos bfd_boolean failed;
6403 1.1 skrll unsigned int count, num_sec;
6404 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6405 1.1 skrll
6406 1.1 skrll if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6407 1.1 skrll && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6408 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6409 1.1 skrll
6410 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6411 1.1 skrll
6412 1.1 skrll failed = FALSE;
6413 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6414 1.1 skrll if (failed)
6415 1.6 christos return FALSE;
6416 1.6 christos
6417 1.1 skrll if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6418 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6419 1.1 skrll
6420 1.1 skrll /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6421 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6422 1.6 christos for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6423 1.6 christos {
6424 1.6 christos i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6425 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6426 1.13 christos i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6427 1.13 christos if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6428 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6429 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6430 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6431 1.1 skrll {
6432 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6433 1.1 skrll
6434 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6435 1.1 skrll || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6436 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6437 1.1 skrll }
6438 1.1 skrll }
6439 1.6 christos
6440 1.1 skrll /* Write out the section header names. */
6441 1.6 christos t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6442 1.1 skrll if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6443 1.1 skrll && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6444 1.1 skrll || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6445 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6446 1.6 christos
6447 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6448 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6449 1.1 skrll
6450 1.1 skrll if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6451 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6452 1.6 christos
6453 1.6 christos /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6454 1.1 skrll if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6455 1.1 skrll return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6456 1.1 skrll
6457 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6458 1.1 skrll }
6459 1.1 skrll
6460 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6461 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6462 1.1 skrll {
6463 1.1 skrll /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6464 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6465 1.1 skrll }
6466 1.1 skrll
6467 1.1 skrll /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6468 1.1 skrll
6469 1.1 skrll unsigned int
6470 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6471 1.3 christos {
6472 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6473 1.1 skrll unsigned int sec_index;
6474 1.1 skrll
6475 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6476 1.1 skrll && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6477 1.1 skrll return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6478 1.3 christos
6479 1.1 skrll if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6480 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6481 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6482 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6483 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6484 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6485 1.1 skrll else
6486 1.1 skrll sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6487 1.1 skrll
6488 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6489 1.3 christos if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6490 1.1 skrll {
6491 1.1 skrll int retval = sec_index;
6492 1.1 skrll
6493 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6494 1.1 skrll return retval;
6495 1.3 christos }
6496 1.1 skrll
6497 1.1 skrll if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6498 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6499 1.1 skrll
6500 1.1 skrll return sec_index;
6501 1.1 skrll }
6502 1.1 skrll
6503 1.1 skrll /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6504 1.1 skrll on error. */
6505 1.1 skrll
6506 1.1 skrll int
6507 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6508 1.1 skrll {
6509 1.1 skrll asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6510 1.1 skrll int idx;
6511 1.1 skrll flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6512 1.1 skrll
6513 1.1 skrll /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6514 1.1 skrll own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6515 1.1 skrll symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6516 1.1 skrll relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6517 1.1 skrll input sections rather than the output section. */
6518 1.1 skrll if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6519 1.1 skrll && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6520 1.1 skrll && asym_ptr->section)
6521 1.1 skrll {
6522 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
6523 1.1 skrll int indx;
6524 1.1 skrll
6525 1.1 skrll sec = asym_ptr->section;
6526 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6527 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
6528 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner == abfd
6529 1.1 skrll && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6530 1.1 skrll && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6531 1.1 skrll asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6532 1.1 skrll }
6533 1.1 skrll
6534 1.1 skrll idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6535 1.1 skrll
6536 1.1 skrll if (idx == 0)
6537 1.1 skrll {
6538 1.9 christos /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6539 1.9 christos which is used in a relocation entry. */
6540 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
6541 1.1 skrll /* xgettext:c-format */
6542 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6543 1.1 skrll abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6544 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6545 1.1 skrll return -1;
6546 1.1 skrll }
6547 1.1 skrll
6548 1.1 skrll #if DEBUG & 4
6549 1.9 christos {
6550 1.9 christos fprintf (stderr,
6551 1.1 skrll "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6552 1.1 skrll (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6553 1.1 skrll fflush (stderr);
6554 1.1 skrll }
6555 1.1 skrll #endif
6556 1.1 skrll
6557 1.1 skrll return idx;
6558 1.1 skrll }
6559 1.1 skrll
6560 1.1 skrll /* Rewrite program header information. */
6561 1.1 skrll
6562 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6563 1.1 skrll rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6564 1.1 skrll {
6565 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6566 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map;
6567 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6568 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6569 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6570 1.1 skrll asection *section;
6571 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6572 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_segments;
6573 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6574 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6575 1.1 skrll bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6576 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6577 1.1 skrll unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6578 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6579 1.1 skrll
6580 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6581 1.1 skrll iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6582 1.1 skrll
6583 1.1 skrll map_first = NULL;
6584 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6585 1.1 skrll
6586 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6587 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6588 1.1 skrll
6589 1.1 skrll /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6590 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6591 1.1 skrll (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6592 1.1 skrll ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6593 1.1 skrll
6594 1.1 skrll #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6595 1.1 skrll (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6596 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6597 1.1 skrll ? section->size : 0)
6598 1.1 skrll
6599 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6600 1.1 skrll the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6601 1.1 skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6602 1.1 skrll (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6603 1.1 skrll && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6604 1.1 skrll <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6605 1.1 skrll
6606 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6607 1.1 skrll the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6608 1.1 skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6609 1.1 skrll (section->lma >= base \
6610 1.1 skrll && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6611 1.1 skrll <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6612 1.1 skrll
6613 1.1 skrll /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6614 1.1 skrll #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6615 1.1 skrll (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6616 1.1 skrll && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6617 1.1 skrll && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6618 1.1 skrll && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6619 1.1 skrll <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6620 1.1 skrll
6621 1.1 skrll /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6622 1.1 skrll etc. */
6623 1.1 skrll #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6624 1.1 skrll (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6625 1.1 skrll && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6626 1.1 skrll && s->vma == 0 \
6627 1.1 skrll && s->lma == 0)
6628 1.1 skrll
6629 1.1 skrll /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6630 1.1 skrll linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6631 1.1 skrll p_memsz set to 0. */
6632 1.1 skrll #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6633 1.1 skrll (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6634 1.1 skrll && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6635 1.1 skrll && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6636 1.1 skrll && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6637 1.1 skrll && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6638 1.1 skrll && s->size > 0 \
6639 1.1 skrll && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6640 1.1 skrll && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6641 1.1 skrll <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6642 1.1 skrll
6643 1.1 skrll /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6644 1.1 skrll A section will be included if:
6645 1.1 skrll 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6646 1.5 christos if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6647 1.1 skrll 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6648 1.1 skrll segment.
6649 1.1 skrll 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6650 1.1 skrll 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6651 1.1 skrll 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6652 1.1 skrll 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6653 1.1 skrll 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6654 1.1 skrll 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6655 1.1 skrll (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6656 1.1 skrll #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6657 1.1 skrll ((((segment->p_paddr \
6658 1.1 skrll ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6659 1.1 skrll : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6660 1.1 skrll && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6661 1.1 skrll || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6662 1.1 skrll && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6663 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6664 1.1 skrll || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6665 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6666 1.1 skrll || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6667 1.1 skrll || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6668 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6669 1.1 skrll || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6670 1.1 skrll || (segment->p_paddr \
6671 1.1 skrll ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6672 1.1 skrll : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6673 1.13 christos || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6674 1.1 skrll == 0)) \
6675 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6676 1.1 skrll
6677 1.1 skrll /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6678 1.1 skrll it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6679 1.1 skrll #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6680 1.1 skrll (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6681 1.1 skrll && section->output_section != NULL)
6682 1.1 skrll
6683 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6684 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6685 1.1 skrll (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6686 1.1 skrll
6687 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6688 1.1 skrll their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6689 1.1 skrll It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6690 1.1 skrll ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6691 1.1 skrll to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6692 1.1 skrll LMA. */
6693 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6694 1.1 skrll ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6695 1.1 skrll || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6696 1.1 skrll && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6697 1.1 skrll || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6698 1.1 skrll
6699 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6700 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6701 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6702 1.1 skrll
6703 1.1 skrll /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6704 1.1 skrll p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6705 1.1 skrll file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6706 1.1 skrll don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6707 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6708 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6709 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6710 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6711 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6712 1.1 skrll {
6713 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6714 1.1 skrll break;
6715 1.1 skrll }
6716 1.1 skrll
6717 1.1 skrll /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6718 1.1 skrll of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6719 1.1 skrll in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6720 1.1 skrll parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6721 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6722 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6723 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6724 1.1 skrll {
6725 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
6726 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6727 1.1 skrll
6728 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6729 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6730 1.1 skrll if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6731 1.1 skrll {
6732 1.1 skrll /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6733 1.1 skrll assignment code will work. */
6734 1.1 skrll segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6735 1.1 skrll break;
6736 1.1 skrll }
6737 1.1 skrll
6738 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6739 1.1 skrll {
6740 1.1 skrll /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6741 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6742 1.1 skrll segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6743 1.1 skrll continue;
6744 1.1 skrll }
6745 1.1 skrll
6746 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6747 1.1 skrll for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6748 1.1 skrll {
6749 1.1 skrll bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6750 1.1 skrll
6751 1.1 skrll if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6752 1.1 skrll || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6753 1.1 skrll continue;
6754 1.1 skrll
6755 1.1 skrll /* Merge the two segments together. */
6756 1.1 skrll if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6757 1.1 skrll {
6758 1.1 skrll /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6759 1.1 skrll SEGMENT. */
6760 1.1 skrll extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6761 1.1 skrll - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6762 1.1 skrll
6763 1.1 skrll if (extra_length > 0)
6764 1.1 skrll {
6765 1.1 skrll segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6766 1.1 skrll segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6767 1.1 skrll }
6768 1.1 skrll
6769 1.1 skrll segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6770 1.1 skrll
6771 1.1 skrll /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6772 1.1 skrll i = 0;
6773 1.1 skrll segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6774 1.1 skrll break;
6775 1.1 skrll }
6776 1.1 skrll else
6777 1.1 skrll {
6778 1.1 skrll /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6779 1.1 skrll SEGMENT2. */
6780 1.1 skrll extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6781 1.1 skrll - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6782 1.1 skrll
6783 1.1 skrll if (extra_length > 0)
6784 1.1 skrll {
6785 1.1 skrll segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6786 1.1 skrll segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6787 1.1 skrll }
6788 1.1 skrll
6789 1.1 skrll segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6790 1.1 skrll }
6791 1.1 skrll }
6792 1.1 skrll }
6793 1.1 skrll
6794 1.1 skrll /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6795 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6796 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6797 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6798 1.1 skrll {
6799 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_count;
6800 1.1 skrll asection **sections;
6801 1.13 christos asection *output_section;
6802 1.13 christos unsigned int isec;
6803 1.1 skrll asection *matching_lma;
6804 1.1 skrll asection *suggested_lma;
6805 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
6806 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
6807 1.1 skrll asection *first_section;
6808 1.1 skrll
6809 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6810 1.1 skrll continue;
6811 1.1 skrll
6812 1.1 skrll first_section = NULL;
6813 1.1 skrll /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6814 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6815 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6816 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6817 1.1 skrll {
6818 1.1 skrll /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6819 1.1 skrll removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6820 1.1 skrll if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6821 1.1 skrll {
6822 1.1 skrll if (first_section == NULL)
6823 1.1 skrll first_section = section;
6824 1.1 skrll if (section->output_section != NULL)
6825 1.1 skrll ++section_count;
6826 1.1 skrll }
6827 1.1 skrll }
6828 1.1 skrll
6829 1.1 skrll /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6830 1.1 skrll all of the sections we have selected. */
6831 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6832 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6833 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6834 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
6835 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6836 1.1 skrll
6837 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6838 1.1 skrll using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6839 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
6840 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6841 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6842 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6843 1.1 skrll
6844 1.1 skrll /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6845 1.1 skrll no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6846 1.1 skrll output segment. */
6847 1.1 skrll if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6848 1.1 skrll {
6849 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6850 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6851 1.1 skrll }
6852 1.1 skrll
6853 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6854 1.1 skrll and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6855 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6856 1.1 skrll && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6857 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6858 1.1 skrll
6859 1.1 skrll if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6860 1.1 skrll {
6861 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs =
6862 1.1 skrll (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6863 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6864 1.1 skrll >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6865 1.1 skrll + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6866 1.1 skrll
6867 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6868 1.1 skrll phdr_included = TRUE;
6869 1.1 skrll }
6870 1.1 skrll
6871 1.1 skrll if (section_count == 0)
6872 1.1 skrll {
6873 1.1 skrll /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6874 1.9 christos no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6875 1.9 christos something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6876 1.9 christos a warning is produced.
6877 1.9 christos There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6878 1.9 christos have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6879 1.9 christos flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6880 1.9 christos if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6881 1.13 christos && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6882 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
6883 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
6884 1.13 christos (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
6885 1.1 skrll " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
6886 1.1 skrll ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
6887 1.1 skrll
6888 1.1 skrll map->count = 0;
6889 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
6890 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6891 1.1 skrll
6892 1.1 skrll continue;
6893 1.1 skrll }
6894 1.1 skrll
6895 1.1 skrll /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6896 1.1 skrll to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6897 1.1 skrll The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6898 1.1 skrll been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6899 1.1 skrll
6900 1.1 skrll 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6901 1.1 skrll In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6902 1.1 skrll input BFD.
6903 1.1 skrll
6904 1.1 skrll 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6905 1.1 skrll In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6906 1.1 skrll of the first section.
6907 1.1 skrll
6908 1.1 skrll 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6909 1.1 skrll In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6910 1.1 skrll placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6911 1.1 skrll and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6912 1.1 skrll have to be created to contain the other sections.
6913 1.1 skrll
6914 1.1 skrll 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6915 1.1 skrll In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6916 1.1 skrll of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6917 1.1 skrll or segments to contain the other sections.
6918 1.1 skrll
6919 1.1 skrll In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6920 1.1 skrll pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6921 1.3 christos to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6922 1.1 skrll
6923 1.1 skrll sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6924 1.1 skrll if (sections == NULL)
6925 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6926 1.1 skrll
6927 1.1 skrll /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6928 1.1 skrll Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6929 1.1 skrll Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6930 1.1 skrll case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6931 1.1 skrll we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6932 1.13 christos more to do. */
6933 1.13 christos isec = 0;
6934 1.1 skrll matching_lma = NULL;
6935 1.7 christos suggested_lma = NULL;
6936 1.1 skrll
6937 1.1 skrll for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6938 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6939 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6940 1.1 skrll {
6941 1.1 skrll if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6942 1.1 skrll {
6943 1.1 skrll output_section = section->output_section;
6944 1.1 skrll
6945 1.1 skrll sections[j++] = section;
6946 1.1 skrll
6947 1.1 skrll /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6948 1.1 skrll We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6949 1.1 skrll correct value. Note - some backends require that
6950 1.1 skrll p_paddr be left as zero. */
6951 1.1 skrll if (!p_paddr_valid
6952 1.1 skrll && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6953 1.1 skrll && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6954 1.13 christos && isec == 0
6955 1.13 christos && output_section->lma != 0
6956 1.13 christos && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
6957 1.13 christos + (map->includes_filehdr
6958 1.13 christos ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6959 1.13 christos + (map->includes_phdrs
6960 1.13 christos ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6961 1.13 christos : 0),
6962 1.1 skrll output_section->alignment_power)
6963 1.1 skrll == output_section->vma))
6964 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6965 1.1 skrll
6966 1.1 skrll /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6967 1.1 skrll LMA address of the output section. */
6968 1.1 skrll if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6969 1.1 skrll || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6970 1.1 skrll || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6971 1.13 christos && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6972 1.13 christos {
6973 1.13 christos if (matching_lma == NULL
6974 1.1 skrll || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
6975 1.1 skrll matching_lma = output_section;
6976 1.1 skrll
6977 1.1 skrll /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6978 1.1 skrll then it does not overlap any other section within that
6979 1.1 skrll segment. */
6980 1.13 christos map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6981 1.13 christos }
6982 1.1 skrll else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
6983 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section;
6984 1.1 skrll
6985 1.1 skrll if (j == section_count)
6986 1.1 skrll break;
6987 1.1 skrll }
6988 1.1 skrll }
6989 1.1 skrll
6990 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6991 1.1 skrll
6992 1.1 skrll /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6993 1.1 skrll if necessary. */
6994 1.1 skrll if (isec == section_count)
6995 1.1 skrll {
6996 1.1 skrll /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6997 1.1 skrll specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6998 1.1 skrll the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6999 1.1 skrll program header in the input BFD. */
7000 1.1 skrll map->count = section_count;
7001 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
7002 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7003 1.1 skrll
7004 1.13 christos if (p_paddr_valid
7005 1.1 skrll && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7006 1.1 skrll && matching_lma->lma != map->p_paddr
7007 1.1 skrll && !map->includes_filehdr
7008 1.1 skrll && !map->includes_phdrs)
7009 1.1 skrll /* There is some padding before the first section in the
7010 1.13 christos segment. So, we must account for that in the output
7011 1.1 skrll segment's vma. */
7012 1.1 skrll map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma->lma - map->p_paddr;
7013 1.1 skrll
7014 1.1 skrll free (sections);
7015 1.1 skrll continue;
7016 1.1 skrll }
7017 1.13 christos else
7018 1.13 christos {
7019 1.13 christos /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7020 1.13 christos the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7021 1.13 christos section fitted, the first section. */
7022 1.13 christos if (matching_lma == NULL)
7023 1.13 christos matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7024 1.1 skrll
7025 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma;
7026 1.1 skrll
7027 1.13 christos /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7028 1.1 skrll to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7029 1.13 christos if (map->includes_phdrs)
7030 1.13 christos {
7031 1.13 christos map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7032 1.13 christos
7033 1.13 christos /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7034 1.13 christos of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7035 1.13 christos here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7036 1.13 christos to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7037 1.13 christos offset when we know the correct value. */
7038 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7039 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7040 1.13 christos }
7041 1.1 skrll
7042 1.13 christos if (map->includes_filehdr)
7043 1.13 christos {
7044 1.13 christos bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7045 1.13 christos map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7046 1.13 christos /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7047 1.13 christos first section lma, but there may have been some
7048 1.13 christos alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7049 1.13 christos account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7050 1.13 christos the same alignment. */
7051 1.13 christos if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7052 1.1 skrll align = segment->p_align;
7053 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr &= -align;
7054 1.1 skrll }
7055 1.1 skrll }
7056 1.1 skrll
7057 1.1 skrll /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7058 1.1 skrll those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7059 1.1 skrll sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7060 1.1 skrll possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7061 1.1 skrll added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7062 1.1 skrll to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7063 1.1 skrll the loop. */
7064 1.1 skrll isec = 0;
7065 1.1 skrll do
7066 1.13 christos {
7067 1.1 skrll map->count = 0;
7068 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = NULL;
7069 1.1 skrll
7070 1.1 skrll /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7071 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7072 1.1 skrll {
7073 1.1 skrll section = sections[j];
7074 1.1 skrll
7075 1.1 skrll if (section == NULL)
7076 1.1 skrll continue;
7077 1.1 skrll
7078 1.1 skrll output_section = section->output_section;
7079 1.1 skrll
7080 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7081 1.1 skrll
7082 1.1 skrll if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7083 1.1 skrll || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7084 1.1 skrll {
7085 1.1 skrll if (map->count == 0)
7086 1.1 skrll {
7087 1.1 skrll /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7088 1.13 christos the beginning of the segment, then something is
7089 1.13 christos wrong. */
7090 1.13 christos if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7091 1.13 christos + (map->includes_filehdr
7092 1.13 christos ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7093 1.13 christos + (map->includes_phdrs
7094 1.13 christos ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7095 1.13 christos : 0),
7096 1.1 skrll output_section->alignment_power)
7097 1.1 skrll != output_section->lma)
7098 1.1 skrll abort ();
7099 1.1 skrll }
7100 1.1 skrll else
7101 1.1 skrll {
7102 1.1 skrll asection *prev_sec;
7103 1.1 skrll
7104 1.1 skrll prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7105 1.1 skrll
7106 1.1 skrll /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7107 1.1 skrll and the start of this section is more than
7108 1.1 skrll maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7109 1.1 skrll if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7110 1.1 skrll maxpagesize)
7111 1.1 skrll < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7112 1.1 skrll || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7113 1.13 christos > output_section->lma))
7114 1.13 christos {
7115 1.1 skrll if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7116 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section;
7117 1.1 skrll
7118 1.1 skrll continue;
7119 1.1 skrll }
7120 1.1 skrll }
7121 1.1 skrll
7122 1.1 skrll map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7123 1.13 christos ++isec;
7124 1.13 christos sections[j] = NULL;
7125 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7126 1.13 christos section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7127 1.13 christos }
7128 1.1 skrll else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7129 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section;
7130 1.1 skrll }
7131 1.1 skrll
7132 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7133 1.1 skrll
7134 1.1 skrll /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7135 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
7136 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7137 1.1 skrll
7138 1.1 skrll if (isec < section_count)
7139 1.1 skrll {
7140 1.1 skrll /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7141 1.1 skrll segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7142 1.1 skrll and carry on looping. */
7143 1.5 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7144 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7145 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7146 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
7147 1.1 skrll {
7148 1.1 skrll free (sections);
7149 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7150 1.1 skrll }
7151 1.1 skrll
7152 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7153 1.1 skrll physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7154 1.1 skrll not yet been assigned. */
7155 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
7156 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7157 1.13 christos map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7158 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7159 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma;
7160 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7161 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7162 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7163 1.1 skrll }
7164 1.1 skrll }
7165 1.1 skrll while (isec < section_count);
7166 1.1 skrll
7167 1.1 skrll free (sections);
7168 1.6 christos }
7169 1.1 skrll
7170 1.1 skrll elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7171 1.1 skrll
7172 1.1 skrll /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7173 1.1 skrll going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7174 1.1 skrll the offset if necessary. */
7175 1.1 skrll if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7176 1.1 skrll {
7177 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
7178 1.1 skrll
7179 1.1 skrll for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7180 1.1 skrll count++;
7181 1.1 skrll
7182 1.1 skrll if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7183 1.13 christos phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7184 1.13 christos -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7185 1.13 christos
7186 1.13 christos for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7187 1.13 christos if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7188 1.13 christos {
7189 1.13 christos bfd_vma adjust
7190 1.13 christos = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7191 1.13 christos map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7192 1.1 skrll break;
7193 1.1 skrll }
7194 1.1 skrll }
7195 1.1 skrll
7196 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_END
7197 1.1 skrll #undef SECTION_SIZE
7198 1.1 skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7199 1.1 skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7200 1.1 skrll #undef IS_NOTE
7201 1.1 skrll #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7202 1.1 skrll #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7203 1.1 skrll #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7204 1.1 skrll #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7205 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7206 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7207 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7208 1.1 skrll }
7209 1.1 skrll
7210 1.1 skrll /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7211 1.1 skrll
7212 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7213 1.1 skrll copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7214 1.1 skrll {
7215 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7216 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map;
7217 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7218 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7219 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7220 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
7221 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_segments;
7222 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7223 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7224 1.1 skrll
7225 1.1 skrll iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7226 1.1 skrll
7227 1.1 skrll map_first = NULL;
7228 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7229 1.1 skrll
7230 1.1 skrll /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7231 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid. */
7232 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7233 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7234 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7235 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
7236 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
7237 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7238 1.1 skrll {
7239 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7240 1.1 skrll break;
7241 1.1 skrll }
7242 1.1 skrll
7243 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7244 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
7245 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
7246 1.1 skrll {
7247 1.1 skrll asection *section;
7248 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_count;
7249 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
7250 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7251 1.1 skrll asection *first_section = NULL;
7252 1.1 skrll asection *lowest_section;
7253 1.1 skrll
7254 1.1 skrll /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7255 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7256 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
7257 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
7258 1.3 christos {
7259 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7260 1.3 christos if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7261 1.3 christos {
7262 1.1 skrll if (first_section == NULL)
7263 1.1 skrll first_section = section;
7264 1.1 skrll section_count++;
7265 1.1 skrll }
7266 1.1 skrll }
7267 1.1 skrll
7268 1.1 skrll /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7269 1.1 skrll all of the sections we have selected. */
7270 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7271 1.3 christos if (section_count != 0)
7272 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7273 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7274 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
7275 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7276 1.1 skrll
7277 1.1 skrll /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7278 1.1 skrll input segment. */
7279 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
7280 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7281 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7282 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7283 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7284 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7285 1.1 skrll map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7286 1.1 skrll map->p_align_valid = 1;
7287 1.6 christos map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7288 1.6 christos
7289 1.1 skrll if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7290 1.1 skrll || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7291 1.1 skrll {
7292 1.1 skrll /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7293 1.6 christos bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7294 1.6 christos section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7295 1.6 christos change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7296 1.3 christos Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7297 1.1 skrll systems. */
7298 1.1 skrll map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7299 1.1 skrll map->p_size_valid = 1;
7300 1.1 skrll }
7301 1.1 skrll
7302 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7303 1.1 skrll and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7304 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7305 1.1 skrll && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7306 1.1 skrll
7307 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7308 1.1 skrll if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7309 1.1 skrll {
7310 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs =
7311 1.1 skrll (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7312 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7313 1.1 skrll >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7314 1.1 skrll + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7315 1.1 skrll
7316 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7317 1.1 skrll phdr_included = TRUE;
7318 1.6 christos }
7319 1.1 skrll
7320 1.1 skrll lowest_section = NULL;
7321 1.1 skrll if (section_count != 0)
7322 1.1 skrll {
7323 1.1 skrll unsigned int isec = 0;
7324 1.1 skrll
7325 1.1 skrll for (section = first_section;
7326 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
7327 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
7328 1.3 christos {
7329 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7330 1.1 skrll if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7331 1.3 christos {
7332 1.3 christos map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7333 1.3 christos if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7334 1.3 christos {
7335 1.6 christos bfd_vma seg_off;
7336 1.6 christos
7337 1.6 christos if (lowest_section == NULL
7338 1.6 christos || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7339 1.3 christos lowest_section = section;
7340 1.3 christos
7341 1.3 christos /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7342 1.3 christos p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7343 1.3 christos If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7344 1.3 christos with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7345 1.3 christos invalid. */
7346 1.3 christos if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7347 1.3 christos seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7348 1.3 christos else
7349 1.3 christos seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7350 1.3 christos if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7351 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7352 1.1 skrll }
7353 1.1 skrll if (isec == section_count)
7354 1.1 skrll break;
7355 1.1 skrll }
7356 1.1 skrll }
7357 1.3 christos }
7358 1.3 christos
7359 1.3 christos if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7360 1.5 christos /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
7361 1.3 christos map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
7362 1.3 christos
7363 1.3 christos if (!map->includes_phdrs
7364 1.3 christos && !map->includes_filehdr
7365 1.3 christos && map->p_paddr_valid)
7366 1.3 christos /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7367 1.3 christos map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7368 1.1 skrll - segment->p_paddr);
7369 1.1 skrll
7370 1.1 skrll map->count = section_count;
7371 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
7372 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7373 1.6 christos }
7374 1.1 skrll
7375 1.1 skrll elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7376 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7377 1.1 skrll }
7378 1.1 skrll
7379 1.1 skrll /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7380 1.1 skrll information. */
7381 1.1 skrll
7382 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
7383 1.1 skrll copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7384 1.1 skrll {
7385 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7386 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7387 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7388 1.1 skrll
7389 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7390 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7391 1.1 skrll
7392 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7393 1.1 skrll {
7394 1.1 skrll /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7395 1.1 skrll covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7396 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7397 1.1 skrll asection *section, *osec;
7398 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_segments;
7399 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7400 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7401 1.1 skrll
7402 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7403 1.1 skrll
7404 1.1 skrll /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7405 1.1 skrll if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7406 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
7407 1.1 skrll
7408 1.1 skrll /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7409 1.1 skrll for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7410 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
7411 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7412 1.1 skrll
7413 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7414 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7415 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
7416 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
7417 1.1 skrll {
7418 1.1 skrll /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7419 1.1 skrll and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7420 1.1 skrll which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7421 1.1 skrll map in this case. */
7422 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7423 1.1 skrll && segment->p_memsz == 0
7424 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7425 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
7426 1.1 skrll
7427 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections;
7428 1.1 skrll section != NULL; section = section->next)
7429 1.1 skrll {
7430 1.1 skrll /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7431 1.1 skrll from the input BFD. */
7432 1.1 skrll osec = section->output_section;
7433 1.1 skrll if (osec)
7434 1.1 skrll osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7435 1.1 skrll
7436 1.3 christos /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7437 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7438 1.1 skrll if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7439 1.1 skrll {
7440 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7441 1.1 skrll removed. What else do we need to check? */
7442 1.1 skrll if (osec == NULL
7443 1.1 skrll || section->flags != osec->flags
7444 1.1 skrll || section->lma != osec->lma
7445 1.1 skrll || section->vma != osec->vma
7446 1.1 skrll || section->size != osec->size
7447 1.1 skrll || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7448 1.1 skrll || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7449 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
7450 1.1 skrll }
7451 1.1 skrll }
7452 1.1 skrll }
7453 1.1 skrll
7454 1.1 skrll /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7455 1.1 skrll input BFD. */
7456 1.1 skrll for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7457 1.9 christos section = section->next)
7458 1.1 skrll {
7459 1.1 skrll if (!section->segment_mark)
7460 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
7461 1.1 skrll else
7462 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7463 1.1 skrll }
7464 1.1 skrll
7465 1.1 skrll return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7466 1.1 skrll }
7467 1.5 christos
7468 1.5 christos rewrite:
7469 1.5 christos if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7470 1.5 christos {
7471 1.5 christos /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7472 1.5 christos the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7473 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7474 1.5 christos unsigned int i;
7475 1.5 christos unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7476 1.5 christos bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7477 1.5 christos
7478 1.5 christos for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7479 1.5 christos i < num_segments;
7480 1.5 christos i++, segment++)
7481 1.6 christos if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7482 1.6 christos && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7483 1.6 christos {
7484 1.9 christos /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7485 1.13 christos if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7486 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7487 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7488 1.6 christos PRIx64 " is too large"),
7489 1.6 christos ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7490 1.6 christos else
7491 1.5 christos maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7492 1.5 christos }
7493 1.5 christos
7494 1.5 christos if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7495 1.5 christos bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7496 1.1 skrll }
7497 1.1 skrll
7498 1.1 skrll return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7499 1.1 skrll }
7500 1.1 skrll
7501 1.1 skrll /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7502 1.1 skrll
7503 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7504 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7505 1.1 skrll asection *isec,
7506 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
7507 1.1 skrll asection *osec,
7508 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7509 1.1 skrll
7510 1.6 christos {
7511 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7512 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7513 1.1 skrll && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7514 1.1 skrll
7515 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7516 1.1 skrll || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7517 1.5 christos return TRUE;
7518 1.5 christos
7519 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7520 1.3 christos
7521 1.3 christos /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7522 1.3 christos section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7523 1.1 skrll set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7524 1.3 christos that the linker clears to differ. */
7525 1.3 christos if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7526 1.3 christos && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7527 1.3 christos || (final_link
7528 1.1 skrll && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7529 1.1 skrll & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7530 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7531 1.1 skrll
7532 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7533 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7534 1.9 christos & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7535 1.9 christos
7536 1.9 christos /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7537 1.9 christos if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7538 1.9 christos elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7539 1.1 skrll = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7540 1.1 skrll
7541 1.1 skrll /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7542 1.1 skrll SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7543 1.9 christos to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7544 1.9 christos See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7545 1.9 christos if ((link_info == NULL
7546 1.9 christos || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7547 1.9 christos && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7548 1.9 christos || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7549 1.9 christos {
7550 1.9 christos if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7551 1.9 christos elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7552 1.9 christos elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7553 1.6 christos elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7554 1.9 christos }
7555 1.9 christos
7556 1.9 christos /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7557 1.9 christos if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7558 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7559 1.1 skrll & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7560 1.1 skrll
7561 1.1 skrll ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7562 1.1 skrll
7563 1.1 skrll /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7564 1.1 skrll don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7565 1.1 skrll may be NULL at this point. */
7566 1.1 skrll if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7567 1.1 skrll {
7568 1.1 skrll ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7569 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7570 1.1 skrll elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7571 1.1 skrll }
7572 1.1 skrll
7573 1.1 skrll osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7574 1.1 skrll
7575 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7576 1.1 skrll }
7577 1.1 skrll
7578 1.1 skrll /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7579 1.1 skrll field, and sometimes the info field. */
7580 1.1 skrll
7581 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7582 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7583 1.1 skrll asection *isec,
7584 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
7585 1.1 skrll asection *osec)
7586 1.1 skrll {
7587 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7588 1.1 skrll
7589 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7590 1.1 skrll || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7591 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7592 1.1 skrll
7593 1.1 skrll ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7594 1.1 skrll ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7595 1.1 skrll
7596 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7597 1.1 skrll
7598 1.1 skrll if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7599 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7600 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7601 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7602 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7603 1.1 skrll
7604 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7605 1.1 skrll NULL);
7606 1.3 christos }
7607 1.3 christos
7608 1.3 christos /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7609 1.3 christos necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7610 1.3 christos the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7611 1.3 christos output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7612 1.1 skrll function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7613 1.1 skrll from the linker. */
7614 1.3 christos
7615 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7616 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7617 1.1 skrll {
7618 1.1 skrll asection *isec;
7619 1.3 christos
7620 1.1 skrll for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7621 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7622 1.1 skrll {
7623 1.3 christos asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7624 1.3 christos asection *s = first;
7625 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7626 1.1 skrll
7627 1.3 christos while (s != NULL)
7628 1.3 christos {
7629 1.3 christos /* If this member section is being output but the
7630 1.3 christos SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7631 1.3 christos set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7632 1.1 skrll if (s->output_section != discarded
7633 1.1 skrll && isec->output_section == discarded)
7634 1.1 skrll {
7635 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7636 1.3 christos elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7637 1.3 christos }
7638 1.3 christos /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7639 1.3 christos but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7640 1.13 christos else if (s->output_section == discarded
7641 1.13 christos && isec->output_section != discarded)
7642 1.13 christos {
7643 1.13 christos struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7644 1.13 christos removed += 4;
7645 1.13 christos if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7646 1.13 christos && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7647 1.13 christos removed += 4;
7648 1.13 christos if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7649 1.13 christos && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7650 1.1 skrll removed += 4;
7651 1.1 skrll }
7652 1.1 skrll s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7653 1.1 skrll if (s == first)
7654 1.3 christos break;
7655 1.3 christos }
7656 1.3 christos if (removed != 0)
7657 1.3 christos {
7658 1.3 christos if (discarded != NULL)
7659 1.13 christos {
7660 1.3 christos /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7661 1.3 christos adjust the input section size. */
7662 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7663 1.13 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7664 1.13 christos isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7665 1.13 christos if (isec->size <= 4)
7666 1.13 christos {
7667 1.13 christos isec->size = 0;
7668 1.3 christos isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7669 1.3 christos }
7670 1.3 christos }
7671 1.3 christos else
7672 1.3 christos {
7673 1.3 christos /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7674 1.13 christos objcopy. */
7675 1.13 christos isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7676 1.13 christos if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7677 1.13 christos {
7678 1.13 christos isec->output_section->size = 0;
7679 1.3 christos isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7680 1.3 christos }
7681 1.1 skrll }
7682 1.1 skrll }
7683 1.1 skrll }
7684 1.1 skrll
7685 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7686 1.3 christos }
7687 1.3 christos
7688 1.3 christos /* Copy private header information. */
7689 1.3 christos
7690 1.3 christos bfd_boolean
7691 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7692 1.3 christos {
7693 1.3 christos if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7694 1.3 christos || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7695 1.3 christos return TRUE;
7696 1.3 christos
7697 1.3 christos /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7698 1.3 christos This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7699 1.3 christos entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7700 1.6 christos contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7701 1.3 christos already been worked out. */
7702 1.3 christos if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7703 1.3 christos {
7704 1.3 christos if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7705 1.3 christos return FALSE;
7706 1.3 christos }
7707 1.3 christos
7708 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7709 1.1 skrll }
7710 1.1 skrll
7711 1.1 skrll /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7712 1.1 skrll which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7713 1.1 skrll index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7714 1.1 skrll section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7715 1.1 skrll swap_out_syms function. */
7716 1.1 skrll
7717 1.1 skrll #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7718 1.1 skrll #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7719 1.1 skrll #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7720 1.1 skrll #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7721 1.1 skrll #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7722 1.1 skrll
7723 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7724 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7725 1.1 skrll asymbol *isymarg,
7726 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
7727 1.1 skrll asymbol *osymarg)
7728 1.1 skrll {
7729 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7730 1.1 skrll
7731 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7732 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7733 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7734 1.1 skrll
7735 1.1 skrll isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7736 1.1 skrll osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7737 1.1 skrll
7738 1.1 skrll if (isym != NULL
7739 1.1 skrll && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7740 1.1 skrll && osym != NULL
7741 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7742 1.1 skrll {
7743 1.1 skrll unsigned int shndx;
7744 1.1 skrll
7745 1.1 skrll shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7746 1.1 skrll if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7747 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7748 1.6 christos else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7749 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7750 1.6 christos else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7751 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
7752 1.6 christos else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7753 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7754 1.1 skrll else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7755 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7756 1.1 skrll osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7757 1.1 skrll }
7758 1.1 skrll
7759 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7760 1.1 skrll }
7761 1.1 skrll
7762 1.1 skrll /* Swap out the symbols. */
7763 1.1 skrll
7764 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
7765 1.1 skrll swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7766 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7767 1.1 skrll int relocatable_p)
7768 1.1 skrll {
7769 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7770 1.6 christos int symcount;
7771 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms;
7772 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7773 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7774 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7775 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7776 1.1 skrll struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7777 1.6 christos bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7778 1.6 christos bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7779 1.1 skrll unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7780 1.6 christos unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7781 1.1 skrll int idx;
7782 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_locals;
7783 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
7784 1.6 christos bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7785 1.1 skrll
7786 1.1 skrll if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7787 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7788 1.6 christos
7789 1.1 skrll /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7790 1.1 skrll stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7791 1.1 skrll if (stt == NULL)
7792 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7793 1.1 skrll
7794 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7795 1.1 skrll symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7796 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7797 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7798 1.6 christos symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7799 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7800 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7801 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7802 1.1 skrll
7803 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7804 1.6 christos symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7805 1.6 christos
7806 1.6 christos /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7807 1.6 christos symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7808 1.6 christos * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7809 1.6 christos if (symstrtab == NULL)
7810 1.6 christos {
7811 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7812 1.6 christos return FALSE;
7813 1.3 christos }
7814 1.9 christos
7815 1.1 skrll outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7816 1.1 skrll bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7817 1.6 christos if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7818 1.6 christos {
7819 1.6 christos error_return:
7820 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7821 1.1 skrll free (symstrtab);
7822 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7823 1.6 christos }
7824 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7825 1.1 skrll outbound_syms_index = 0;
7826 1.6 christos
7827 1.6 christos outbound_shndx = NULL;
7828 1.6 christos outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7829 1.1 skrll
7830 1.6 christos if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7831 1.6 christos {
7832 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7833 1.6 christos if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7834 1.6 christos {
7835 1.6 christos amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7836 1.6 christos outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7837 1.6 christos bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7838 1.6 christos if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7839 1.6 christos goto error_return;
7840 1.6 christos
7841 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7842 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7843 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7844 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7845 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7846 1.1 skrll }
7847 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7848 1.1 skrll }
7849 1.1 skrll
7850 1.1 skrll /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7851 1.1 skrll {
7852 1.1 skrll /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7853 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7854 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = 0;
7855 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = 0;
7856 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = 0;
7857 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = 0;
7858 1.5 christos sym.st_other = 0;
7859 1.6 christos sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7860 1.6 christos sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7861 1.6 christos symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7862 1.6 christos symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7863 1.1 skrll symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7864 1.6 christos outbound_syms_index++;
7865 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7866 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx_index++;
7867 1.1 skrll }
7868 1.1 skrll
7869 1.1 skrll name_local_sections
7870 1.1 skrll = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7871 1.1 skrll && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7872 1.6 christos
7873 1.1 skrll syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7874 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7875 1.1 skrll {
7876 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7877 1.1 skrll bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7878 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7879 1.1 skrll flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7880 1.1 skrll int type;
7881 1.1 skrll
7882 1.1 skrll if (!name_local_sections
7883 1.1 skrll && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7884 1.6 christos {
7885 1.1 skrll /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7886 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7887 1.1 skrll }
7888 1.6 christos else
7889 1.6 christos {
7890 1.6 christos /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7891 1.6 christos to get the final offset for st_name. */
7892 1.6 christos sym.st_name
7893 1.1 skrll = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7894 1.6 christos FALSE);
7895 1.1 skrll if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7896 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7897 1.1 skrll }
7898 1.1 skrll
7899 1.1 skrll type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7900 1.1 skrll
7901 1.1 skrll if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7902 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7903 1.1 skrll {
7904 1.1 skrll /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7905 1.1 skrll and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7906 1.1 skrll how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7907 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = value;
7908 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr == NULL
7909 1.1 skrll || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7910 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7911 1.1 skrll else
7912 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7913 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7914 1.1 skrll (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7915 1.1 skrll }
7916 1.1 skrll else
7917 1.1 skrll {
7918 1.1 skrll asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7919 1.1 skrll unsigned int shndx;
7920 1.1 skrll
7921 1.1 skrll if (sec->output_section)
7922 1.1 skrll {
7923 1.1 skrll value += sec->output_offset;
7924 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
7925 1.1 skrll }
7926 1.1 skrll
7927 1.1 skrll /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7928 1.1 skrll if (! relocatable_p)
7929 1.1 skrll value += sec->vma;
7930 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = value;
7931 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7932 1.1 skrll
7933 1.1 skrll if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7934 1.1 skrll && type_ptr != NULL
7935 1.1 skrll && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7936 1.1 skrll {
7937 1.1 skrll /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7938 1.1 skrll not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7939 1.1 skrll by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7940 1.1 skrll shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7941 1.1 skrll switch (shndx)
7942 1.1 skrll {
7943 1.1 skrll case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
7944 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7945 1.1 skrll break;
7946 1.1 skrll case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
7947 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7948 1.6 christos break;
7949 1.1 skrll case MAP_STRTAB:
7950 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7951 1.6 christos break;
7952 1.1 skrll case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
7953 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7954 1.6 christos break;
7955 1.6 christos case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
7956 1.1 skrll if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7957 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7958 1.5 christos break;
7959 1.1 skrll default:
7960 1.1 skrll shndx = SHN_ABS;
7961 1.1 skrll break;
7962 1.1 skrll }
7963 1.1 skrll }
7964 1.1 skrll else
7965 1.1 skrll {
7966 1.1 skrll shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7967 1.1 skrll
7968 1.1 skrll if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7969 1.1 skrll {
7970 1.1 skrll asection *sec2;
7971 1.1 skrll
7972 1.1 skrll /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7973 1.1 skrll we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7974 1.1 skrll knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7975 1.1 skrll demand of applications. For example, it
7976 1.1 skrll appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7977 1.1 skrll section of a symbol to be a section that is
7978 1.9 christos actually in the output file. */
7979 1.9 christos sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7980 1.9 christos if (sec2 != NULL)
7981 1.1 skrll shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7982 1.9 christos if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7983 1.13 christos {
7984 1.13 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7985 1.13 christos _bfd_error_handler
7986 1.13 christos (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
7987 1.13 christos " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7988 1.1 skrll syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7989 1.6 christos sec->name);
7990 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7991 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7992 1.1 skrll }
7993 1.1 skrll }
7994 1.1 skrll }
7995 1.1 skrll
7996 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7997 1.1 skrll }
7998 1.1 skrll
7999 1.3 christos if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8000 1.3 christos type = STT_TLS;
8001 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
8002 1.1 skrll type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8003 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8004 1.1 skrll type = STT_FUNC;
8005 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8006 1.1 skrll type = STT_OBJECT;
8007 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8008 1.1 skrll type = STT_RELC;
8009 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8010 1.1 skrll type = STT_SRELC;
8011 1.1 skrll else
8012 1.1 skrll type = STT_NOTYPE;
8013 1.1 skrll
8014 1.1 skrll if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8015 1.1 skrll type = STT_TLS;
8016 1.1 skrll
8017 1.1 skrll /* Processor-specific types. */
8018 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr != NULL
8019 1.1 skrll && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8020 1.1 skrll type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8021 1.1 skrll (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8022 1.1 skrll
8023 1.1 skrll if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8024 1.1 skrll {
8025 1.1 skrll if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8026 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8027 1.1 skrll else
8028 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8029 1.1 skrll }
8030 1.7 christos else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8031 1.7 christos {
8032 1.7 christos if (type != STT_TLS)
8033 1.7 christos {
8034 1.7 christos if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8035 1.7 christos type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8036 1.7 christos ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8037 1.7 christos else
8038 1.7 christos type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8039 1.7 christos ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8040 1.1 skrll }
8041 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8042 1.1 skrll }
8043 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8044 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8045 1.1 skrll ? STB_WEAK
8046 1.1 skrll : STB_GLOBAL),
8047 1.1 skrll type);
8048 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8049 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8050 1.1 skrll else
8051 1.1 skrll {
8052 1.1 skrll int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8053 1.1 skrll
8054 1.3 christos if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8055 1.3 christos bind = STB_LOCAL;
8056 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8057 1.1 skrll bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8058 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8059 1.1 skrll bind = STB_WEAK;
8060 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8061 1.1 skrll bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8062 1.1 skrll
8063 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8064 1.1 skrll }
8065 1.5 christos
8066 1.5 christos if (type_ptr != NULL)
8067 1.5 christos {
8068 1.5 christos sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8069 1.5 christos sym.st_target_internal
8070 1.1 skrll = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8071 1.5 christos }
8072 1.5 christos else
8073 1.5 christos {
8074 1.5 christos sym.st_other = 0;
8075 1.1 skrll sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8076 1.6 christos }
8077 1.6 christos
8078 1.6 christos idx++;
8079 1.6 christos symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8080 1.6 christos symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8081 1.6 christos symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8082 1.1 skrll
8083 1.6 christos outbound_syms_index++;
8084 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8085 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx_index++;
8086 1.6 christos }
8087 1.6 christos
8088 1.6 christos /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8089 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8090 1.6 christos
8091 1.6 christos /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8092 1.6 christos for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8093 1.6 christos {
8094 1.6 christos struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8095 1.6 christos if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8096 1.6 christos elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8097 1.6 christos else
8098 1.6 christos elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8099 1.6 christos elfsym->sym.st_name);
8100 1.6 christos bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8101 1.6 christos (outbound_syms
8102 1.6 christos + (elfsym->dest_index
8103 1.6 christos * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8104 1.6 christos (outbound_shndx
8105 1.6 christos + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8106 1.6 christos * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8107 1.6 christos }
8108 1.1 skrll free (symstrtab);
8109 1.6 christos
8110 1.1 skrll *sttp = stt;
8111 1.7 christos symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8112 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8113 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8114 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8115 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8116 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8117 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8118 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8119 1.1 skrll
8120 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8121 1.1 skrll }
8122 1.1 skrll
8123 1.1 skrll /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8124 1.1 skrll
8125 1.1 skrll Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8126 1.1 skrll the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8127 1.1 skrll always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8128 1.1 skrll
8129 1.1 skrll long
8130 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8131 1.1 skrll {
8132 1.1 skrll long symcount;
8133 1.1 skrll long symtab_size;
8134 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8135 1.1 skrll
8136 1.1 skrll symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8137 1.1 skrll symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8138 1.1 skrll if (symcount > 0)
8139 1.1 skrll symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8140 1.1 skrll
8141 1.1 skrll return symtab_size;
8142 1.1 skrll }
8143 1.1 skrll
8144 1.1 skrll long
8145 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8146 1.1 skrll {
8147 1.1 skrll long symcount;
8148 1.1 skrll long symtab_size;
8149 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8150 1.1 skrll
8151 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8152 1.1 skrll {
8153 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8154 1.1 skrll return -1;
8155 1.1 skrll }
8156 1.1 skrll
8157 1.1 skrll symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8158 1.1 skrll symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8159 1.1 skrll if (symcount > 0)
8160 1.1 skrll symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8161 1.1 skrll
8162 1.1 skrll return symtab_size;
8163 1.1 skrll }
8164 1.1 skrll
8165 1.1 skrll long
8166 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8167 1.1 skrll sec_ptr asect)
8168 1.1 skrll {
8169 1.1 skrll return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8170 1.1 skrll }
8171 1.1 skrll
8172 1.1 skrll /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8173 1.1 skrll
8174 1.1 skrll long
8175 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8176 1.1 skrll sec_ptr section,
8177 1.1 skrll arelent **relptr,
8178 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols)
8179 1.1 skrll {
8180 1.1 skrll arelent *tblptr;
8181 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
8182 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8183 1.1 skrll
8184 1.1 skrll if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8185 1.1 skrll return -1;
8186 1.1 skrll
8187 1.1 skrll tblptr = section->relocation;
8188 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8189 1.1 skrll *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8190 1.1 skrll
8191 1.1 skrll *relptr = NULL;
8192 1.1 skrll
8193 1.1 skrll return section->reloc_count;
8194 1.1 skrll }
8195 1.1 skrll
8196 1.1 skrll long
8197 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8198 1.1 skrll {
8199 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8200 1.1 skrll long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8201 1.1 skrll
8202 1.1 skrll if (symcount >= 0)
8203 1.1 skrll bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8204 1.1 skrll return symcount;
8205 1.1 skrll }
8206 1.1 skrll
8207 1.1 skrll long
8208 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8209 1.1 skrll asymbol **allocation)
8210 1.1 skrll {
8211 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8212 1.1 skrll long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8213 1.1 skrll
8214 1.1 skrll if (symcount >= 0)
8215 1.1 skrll bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8216 1.1 skrll return symcount;
8217 1.1 skrll }
8218 1.1 skrll
8219 1.1 skrll /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8220 1.1 skrll section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8221 1.1 skrll or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8222 1.1 skrll dynamic reloc section. */
8223 1.1 skrll
8224 1.1 skrll long
8225 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8226 1.1 skrll {
8227 1.1 skrll long ret;
8228 1.1 skrll asection *s;
8229 1.1 skrll
8230 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8231 1.1 skrll {
8232 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8233 1.1 skrll return -1;
8234 1.1 skrll }
8235 1.1 skrll
8236 1.1 skrll ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8237 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8238 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8239 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8240 1.1 skrll || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8241 1.1 skrll ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8242 1.1 skrll * sizeof (arelent *));
8243 1.1 skrll
8244 1.1 skrll return ret;
8245 1.1 skrll }
8246 1.1 skrll
8247 1.1 skrll /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8248 1.1 skrll dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8249 1.1 skrll associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8250 1.1 skrll designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8251 1.1 skrll one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8252 1.1 skrll installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8253 1.1 skrll dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8254 1.1 skrll
8255 1.1 skrll long
8256 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8257 1.1 skrll arelent **storage,
8258 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms)
8259 1.1 skrll {
8260 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8261 1.1 skrll asection *s;
8262 1.1 skrll long ret;
8263 1.1 skrll
8264 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8265 1.1 skrll {
8266 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8267 1.1 skrll return -1;
8268 1.1 skrll }
8269 1.1 skrll
8270 1.1 skrll slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8271 1.1 skrll ret = 0;
8272 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8273 1.1 skrll {
8274 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8275 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8276 1.1 skrll || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8277 1.1 skrll {
8278 1.1 skrll arelent *p;
8279 1.1 skrll long count, i;
8280 1.1 skrll
8281 1.1 skrll if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8282 1.1 skrll return -1;
8283 1.1 skrll count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8284 1.1 skrll p = s->relocation;
8285 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8286 1.1 skrll *storage++ = p++;
8287 1.1 skrll ret += count;
8288 1.1 skrll }
8289 1.1 skrll }
8290 1.1 skrll
8291 1.1 skrll *storage = NULL;
8292 1.1 skrll
8293 1.1 skrll return ret;
8294 1.1 skrll }
8295 1.1 skrll
8296 1.1 skrll /* Read in the version information. */
8298 1.1 skrll
8299 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8300 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8301 1.1 skrll {
8302 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8303 1.1 skrll unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8304 1.1 skrll
8305 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8306 1.1 skrll {
8307 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8308 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8309 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8310 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
8311 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents_end;
8312 1.9 christos
8313 1.9 christos hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8314 1.1 skrll
8315 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8316 1.9 christos || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8317 1.13 christos {
8318 1.6 christos error_return_bad_verref:
8319 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
8320 1.1 skrll (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8321 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8322 1.1 skrll error_return_verref:
8323 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8324 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8325 1.6 christos goto error_return;
8326 1.6 christos }
8327 1.6 christos
8328 1.6 christos contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8329 1.1 skrll if (contents == NULL)
8330 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
8331 1.1 skrll
8332 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8333 1.6 christos || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8334 1.9 christos goto error_return_verref;
8335 1.6 christos
8336 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8337 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8338 1.1 skrll
8339 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8340 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
8341 1.1 skrll
8342 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8343 1.1 skrll == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8344 1.1 skrll contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8345 1.1 skrll everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8346 1.1 skrll iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8347 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8348 1.1 skrll {
8349 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8350 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8351 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
8352 1.1 skrll
8353 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8354 1.1 skrll
8355 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8356 1.1 skrll
8357 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_filename =
8358 1.6 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8359 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_file);
8360 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8361 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
8362 1.1 skrll
8363 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8364 1.3 christos iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8365 1.9 christos else
8366 1.9 christos {
8367 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8368 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8369 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8370 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8371 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
8372 1.1 skrll }
8373 1.6 christos
8374 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_aux
8375 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8376 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
8377 1.1 skrll
8378 1.1 skrll evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8379 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8380 1.1 skrll ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8381 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8382 1.1 skrll {
8383 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8384 1.1 skrll
8385 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8386 1.6 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8387 1.6 christos ivernaux->vna_name);
8388 1.6 christos if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8389 1.6 christos goto error_return_bad_verref;
8390 1.1 skrll
8391 1.6 christos if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8392 1.6 christos freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8393 1.6 christos
8394 1.6 christos ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8395 1.6 christos if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8396 1.6 christos {
8397 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8398 1.1 skrll break;
8399 1.1 skrll }
8400 1.1 skrll if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8401 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8402 1.6 christos
8403 1.1 skrll if (ivernaux->vna_next
8404 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8405 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
8406 1.1 skrll
8407 1.1 skrll evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8408 1.6 christos ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8409 1.6 christos }
8410 1.6 christos
8411 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8412 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8413 1.1 skrll break;
8414 1.1 skrll if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8415 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8416 1.6 christos
8417 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_next
8418 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8419 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
8420 1.1 skrll
8421 1.6 christos everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8422 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8423 1.1 skrll }
8424 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8425 1.1 skrll
8426 1.1 skrll free (contents);
8427 1.1 skrll contents = NULL;
8428 1.1 skrll }
8429 1.1 skrll
8430 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8431 1.1 skrll {
8432 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8433 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8434 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8435 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8436 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8437 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
8438 1.1 skrll unsigned int maxidx;
8439 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8440 1.6 christos
8441 1.6 christos hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8442 1.6 christos
8443 1.9 christos if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8444 1.13 christos {
8445 1.6 christos error_return_bad_verdef:
8446 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler
8447 1.6 christos (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8448 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8449 1.6 christos error_return_verdef:
8450 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8451 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8452 1.3 christos goto error_return;
8453 1.1 skrll }
8454 1.6 christos
8455 1.1 skrll contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8456 1.1 skrll if (contents == NULL)
8457 1.6 christos goto error_return_verdef;
8458 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8459 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8460 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
8461 1.1 skrll
8462 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8463 1.1 skrll >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8464 1.1 skrll contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8465 1.1 skrll - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8466 1.1 skrll contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8467 1.1 skrll - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8468 1.1 skrll
8469 1.1 skrll /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8470 1.1 skrll index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8471 1.1 skrll the maximum. */
8472 1.1 skrll everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8473 1.1 skrll maxidx = 0;
8474 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8475 1.6 christos {
8476 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8477 1.1 skrll
8478 1.1 skrll if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8479 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8480 1.6 christos if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8481 1.6 christos maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8482 1.6 christos
8483 1.1 skrll if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8484 1.1 skrll break;
8485 1.6 christos
8486 1.1 skrll if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8487 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8488 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8489 1.1 skrll
8490 1.1 skrll everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8491 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8492 1.1 skrll }
8493 1.1 skrll
8494 1.1 skrll if (default_imported_symver)
8495 1.1 skrll {
8496 1.1 skrll if (freeidx > maxidx)
8497 1.1 skrll maxidx = ++freeidx;
8498 1.6 christos else
8499 1.3 christos freeidx = ++maxidx;
8500 1.6 christos }
8501 1.1 skrll
8502 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8503 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8504 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8505 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
8506 1.1 skrll
8507 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8508 1.1 skrll
8509 1.1 skrll everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8510 1.1 skrll iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8511 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8512 1.1 skrll {
8513 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8514 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8515 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
8516 1.1 skrll
8517 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8518 1.1 skrll
8519 1.1 skrll if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8520 1.6 christos goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8521 1.1 skrll
8522 1.1 skrll iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8523 1.1 skrll memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8524 1.1 skrll
8525 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8526 1.1 skrll
8527 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8528 1.3 christos iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8529 1.9 christos else
8530 1.9 christos {
8531 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8532 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8533 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8534 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8535 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
8536 1.1 skrll }
8537 1.6 christos
8538 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_aux
8539 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8540 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8541 1.1 skrll
8542 1.1 skrll everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8543 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8544 1.1 skrll iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8545 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8546 1.1 skrll {
8547 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8548 1.1 skrll
8549 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8550 1.6 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8551 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_name);
8552 1.6 christos if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8553 1.6 christos goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8554 1.6 christos
8555 1.6 christos iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8556 1.6 christos if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8557 1.6 christos {
8558 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8559 1.1 skrll break;
8560 1.1 skrll }
8561 1.1 skrll if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8562 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8563 1.6 christos
8564 1.1 skrll if (iverdaux->vda_next
8565 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8566 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8567 1.1 skrll
8568 1.1 skrll everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8569 1.6 christos ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8570 1.1 skrll }
8571 1.1 skrll
8572 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8573 1.6 christos if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8574 1.6 christos iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8575 1.6 christos
8576 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8577 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8578 1.1 skrll break;
8579 1.1 skrll if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8580 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8581 1.1 skrll
8582 1.1 skrll everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8583 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8584 1.1 skrll }
8585 1.1 skrll
8586 1.1 skrll free (contents);
8587 1.1 skrll contents = NULL;
8588 1.1 skrll }
8589 1.1 skrll else if (default_imported_symver)
8590 1.1 skrll {
8591 1.1 skrll if (freeidx < 3)
8592 1.1 skrll freeidx = 3;
8593 1.3 christos else
8594 1.9 christos freeidx++;
8595 1.1 skrll
8596 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8597 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8598 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8599 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
8600 1.1 skrll
8601 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8602 1.1 skrll }
8603 1.1 skrll
8604 1.1 skrll /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8605 1.1 skrll if (default_imported_symver)
8606 1.1 skrll {
8607 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8608 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8609 1.1 skrll
8610 1.1 skrll iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8611 1.1 skrll
8612 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8613 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8614 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8615 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8616 1.1 skrll
8617 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8618 1.1 skrll
8619 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8620 1.6 christos if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8621 1.6 christos goto error_return_verdef;
8622 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8623 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8624 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8625 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8626 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
8627 1.1 skrll
8628 1.1 skrll iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8629 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8630 1.1 skrll }
8631 1.1 skrll
8632 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8633 1.1 skrll
8634 1.1 skrll error_return:
8635 1.1 skrll if (contents != NULL)
8636 1.1 skrll free (contents);
8637 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8638 1.1 skrll }
8639 1.1 skrll
8640 1.1 skrll asymbol *
8642 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8643 1.1 skrll {
8644 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8645 1.6 christos
8646 1.6 christos newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8647 1.1 skrll if (!newsym)
8648 1.1 skrll return NULL;
8649 1.1 skrll newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8650 1.1 skrll return &newsym->symbol;
8651 1.1 skrll }
8652 1.1 skrll
8653 1.1 skrll void
8654 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8655 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
8656 1.1 skrll symbol_info *ret)
8657 1.1 skrll {
8658 1.1 skrll bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8659 1.1 skrll }
8660 1.1 skrll
8661 1.1 skrll /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8662 1.1 skrll use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8663 1.1 skrll override it. */
8664 1.1 skrll
8665 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8666 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8667 1.1 skrll const char *name)
8668 1.1 skrll {
8669 1.1 skrll /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8670 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8671 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8672 1.1 skrll
8673 1.1 skrll /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8674 1.1 skrll DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8675 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8676 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8677 1.1 skrll
8678 1.1 skrll /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8679 1.1 skrll emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8680 1.1 skrll small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8681 1.1 skrll ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8682 1.1 skrll underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8683 1.6 christos we treat such symbols as local. */
8684 1.6 christos if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8685 1.6 christos return TRUE;
8686 1.6 christos
8687 1.9 christos /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8688 1.6 christos forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8689 1.6 christos These labels have the form:
8690 1.6 christos
8691 1.6 christos L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8692 1.6 christos
8693 1.6 christos [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8694 1.6 christos
8695 1.6 christos Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8696 1.6 christos so we only need to match the rest. */
8697 1.6 christos if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8698 1.6 christos {
8699 1.6 christos bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8700 1.6 christos const char * p;
8701 1.6 christos char c;
8702 1.6 christos
8703 1.6 christos for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8704 1.6 christos {
8705 1.6 christos if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8706 1.6 christos {
8707 1.6 christos if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8708 1.6 christos /* A fake symbol. */
8709 1.6 christos return TRUE;
8710 1.6 christos
8711 1.6 christos /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8712 1.6 christos L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8713 1.6 christos assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8714 1.6 christos containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8715 1.6 christos other than some kind of local ? */
8716 1.6 christos ret = TRUE;
8717 1.6 christos }
8718 1.6 christos
8719 1.6 christos if (! ISDIGIT (c))
8720 1.6 christos {
8721 1.6 christos ret = FALSE;
8722 1.6 christos break;
8723 1.6 christos }
8724 1.1 skrll }
8725 1.1 skrll return ret;
8726 1.1 skrll }
8727 1.1 skrll
8728 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8729 1.1 skrll }
8730 1.1 skrll
8731 1.1 skrll alent *
8732 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8733 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8734 1.1 skrll {
8735 1.1 skrll abort ();
8736 1.1 skrll return NULL;
8737 1.1 skrll }
8738 1.1 skrll
8739 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8740 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8741 1.1 skrll enum bfd_architecture arch,
8742 1.1 skrll unsigned long machine)
8743 1.1 skrll {
8744 1.1 skrll /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8745 1.1 skrll isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8746 1.1 skrll if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8747 1.1 skrll && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8748 1.1 skrll && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8749 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8750 1.1 skrll
8751 1.1 skrll return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8752 1.1 skrll }
8753 1.1 skrll
8754 1.1 skrll /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8755 1.6 christos for error reporting. */
8756 1.1 skrll
8757 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8758 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8759 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols,
8760 1.6 christos asection *section,
8761 1.6 christos bfd_vma offset,
8762 1.5 christos const char **filename_ptr,
8763 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr,
8764 1.1 skrll unsigned int *line_ptr,
8765 1.6 christos unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8766 1.1 skrll {
8767 1.6 christos bfd_boolean found;
8768 1.6 christos
8769 1.6 christos if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8770 1.6 christos filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8771 1.6 christos line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8772 1.6 christos dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8773 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8774 1.1 skrll || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8775 1.6 christos filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8776 1.6 christos line_ptr))
8777 1.6 christos {
8778 1.1 skrll if (!*functionname_ptr)
8779 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8780 1.1 skrll *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8781 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr);
8782 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8783 1.1 skrll }
8784 1.1 skrll
8785 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8786 1.1 skrll &found, filename_ptr,
8787 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8788 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8789 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8790 1.1 skrll if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8791 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8792 1.6 christos
8793 1.6 christos if (symbols == NULL)
8794 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8795 1.1 skrll
8796 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8797 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8798 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8799 1.1 skrll
8800 1.1 skrll *line_ptr = 0;
8801 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8802 1.1 skrll }
8803 1.1 skrll
8804 1.1 skrll /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8805 1.1 skrll
8806 1.6 christos bfd_boolean
8807 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8808 1.6 christos const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8809 1.6 christos {
8810 1.1 skrll return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8811 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8812 1.1 skrll dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8813 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8814 1.1 skrll }
8815 1.1 skrll
8816 1.1 skrll /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8817 1.1 skrll bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8818 1.1 skrll each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8819 1.1 skrll passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8820 1.1 skrll for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8821 1.1 skrll
8822 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8823 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8824 1.1 skrll const char **filename_ptr,
8825 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr,
8826 1.1 skrll unsigned int *line_ptr)
8827 1.1 skrll {
8828 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean found;
8829 1.1 skrll found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8830 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8831 1.1 skrll & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8832 1.1 skrll return found;
8833 1.1 skrll }
8834 1.1 skrll
8835 1.1 skrll int
8836 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8837 1.6 christos {
8838 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8839 1.6 christos int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8840 1.1 skrll
8841 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8842 1.1 skrll {
8843 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8844 1.1 skrll
8845 1.1 skrll if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8846 1.6 christos {
8847 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
8848 1.1 skrll
8849 1.1 skrll phdr_size = 0;
8850 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8851 1.1 skrll phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8852 1.1 skrll
8853 1.6 christos if (phdr_size == 0)
8854 1.1 skrll phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8855 1.1 skrll }
8856 1.1 skrll
8857 1.1 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8858 1.1 skrll ret += phdr_size;
8859 1.1 skrll }
8860 1.1 skrll
8861 1.1 skrll return ret;
8862 1.1 skrll }
8863 1.1 skrll
8864 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8865 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8866 1.1 skrll sec_ptr section,
8867 1.1 skrll const void *location,
8868 1.6 christos file_ptr offset,
8869 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type count)
8870 1.1 skrll {
8871 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8872 1.1 skrll file_ptr pos;
8873 1.1 skrll
8874 1.6 christos if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8875 1.6 christos && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8876 1.6 christos return FALSE;
8877 1.1 skrll
8878 1.6 christos if (!count)
8879 1.6 christos return TRUE;
8880 1.6 christos
8881 1.6 christos hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8882 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8883 1.6 christos {
8884 1.6 christos /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8885 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8886 1.6 christos if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8887 1.6 christos || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8888 1.6 christos || contents == NULL)
8889 1.1 skrll abort ();
8890 1.1 skrll memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8891 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8892 1.1 skrll }
8893 1.1 skrll pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8894 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8895 1.1 skrll || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8896 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8897 1.13 christos
8898 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8899 1.1 skrll }
8900 1.1 skrll
8901 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8902 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8903 1.13 christos arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8904 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8905 1.1 skrll {
8906 1.1 skrll abort ();
8907 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8908 1.1 skrll }
8909 1.1 skrll
8910 1.1 skrll /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8911 1.1 skrll
8912 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8913 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8914 1.1 skrll {
8915 1.1 skrll /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8916 1.1 skrll
8917 1.1 skrll if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8918 1.1 skrll {
8919 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8920 1.1 skrll reloc_howto_type *howto;
8921 1.1 skrll
8922 1.1 skrll /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8923 1.1 skrll equivalent ELF reloc. */
8924 1.1 skrll
8925 1.1 skrll if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8926 1.1 skrll {
8927 1.1 skrll switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8928 1.1 skrll {
8929 1.1 skrll case 8:
8930 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8931 1.1 skrll break;
8932 1.1 skrll case 12:
8933 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8934 1.1 skrll break;
8935 1.1 skrll case 16:
8936 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8937 1.1 skrll break;
8938 1.1 skrll case 24:
8939 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8940 1.1 skrll break;
8941 1.1 skrll case 32:
8942 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8943 1.1 skrll break;
8944 1.1 skrll case 64:
8945 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8946 1.1 skrll break;
8947 1.1 skrll default:
8948 1.1 skrll goto fail;
8949 1.1 skrll }
8950 1.1 skrll
8951 1.1 skrll howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8952 1.1 skrll
8953 1.1 skrll if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8954 1.1 skrll {
8955 1.1 skrll if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8956 1.1 skrll areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8957 1.1 skrll else
8958 1.1 skrll areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8959 1.1 skrll }
8960 1.1 skrll }
8961 1.1 skrll else
8962 1.1 skrll {
8963 1.1 skrll switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8964 1.1 skrll {
8965 1.1 skrll case 8:
8966 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_8;
8967 1.1 skrll break;
8968 1.1 skrll case 14:
8969 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8970 1.1 skrll break;
8971 1.1 skrll case 16:
8972 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8973 1.1 skrll break;
8974 1.1 skrll case 26:
8975 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8976 1.1 skrll break;
8977 1.1 skrll case 32:
8978 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8979 1.1 skrll break;
8980 1.1 skrll case 64:
8981 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8982 1.1 skrll break;
8983 1.1 skrll default:
8984 1.1 skrll goto fail;
8985 1.1 skrll }
8986 1.1 skrll
8987 1.1 skrll howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8988 1.1 skrll }
8989 1.1 skrll
8990 1.1 skrll if (howto)
8991 1.1 skrll areloc->howto = howto;
8992 1.1 skrll else
8993 1.1 skrll goto fail;
8994 1.1 skrll }
8995 1.13 christos
8996 1.13 christos return TRUE;
8997 1.13 christos
8998 1.1 skrll fail:
8999 1.1 skrll /* xgettext:c-format */
9000 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9001 1.1 skrll abfd, areloc->howto->name);
9002 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9003 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9004 1.1 skrll }
9005 1.5 christos
9006 1.5 christos bfd_boolean
9007 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9008 1.6 christos {
9009 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9010 1.5 christos if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
9011 1.1 skrll {
9012 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9013 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9014 1.1 skrll _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9015 1.1 skrll }
9016 1.1 skrll
9017 1.1 skrll return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9018 1.1 skrll }
9019 1.1 skrll
9020 1.1 skrll /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9021 1.1 skrll in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9022 1.1 skrll range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9023 1.1 skrll this reloc. */
9024 1.1 skrll
9025 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
9026 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9027 1.1 skrll (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9028 1.1 skrll struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9029 1.1 skrll void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9030 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9031 1.1 skrll {
9032 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_ok;
9033 1.1 skrll }
9034 1.1 skrll
9035 1.1 skrll /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9037 1.3 christos toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9038 1.3 christos machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9039 1.1 skrll out details about the corefile. */
9040 1.1 skrll
9041 1.1 skrll #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9042 1.3 christos /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9043 1.3 christos # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9044 1.1 skrll # include <sys/procfs.h>
9045 1.1 skrll #endif
9046 1.1 skrll
9047 1.1 skrll /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9048 1.3 christos PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9049 1.3 christos
9050 1.6 christos static int
9051 1.3 christos elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9052 1.6 christos {
9053 1.3 christos int pid;
9054 1.3 christos
9055 1.1 skrll pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9056 1.1 skrll if (pid == 0)
9057 1.1 skrll pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9058 1.1 skrll
9059 1.1 skrll return pid;
9060 1.1 skrll }
9061 1.1 skrll
9062 1.1 skrll /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9063 1.1 skrll data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9064 1.1 skrll reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9065 1.1 skrll overwrite it. */
9066 1.1 skrll
9067 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9068 1.1 skrll elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9069 1.1 skrll {
9070 1.1 skrll asection *sect2;
9071 1.1 skrll
9072 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9073 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9074 1.1 skrll
9075 1.1 skrll sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9076 1.1 skrll if (sect2 == NULL)
9077 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9078 1.1 skrll
9079 1.1 skrll sect2->size = sect->size;
9080 1.1 skrll sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9081 1.1 skrll sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9082 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9083 1.1 skrll }
9084 1.1 skrll
9085 1.1 skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9086 1.9 christos actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9087 1.1 skrll - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9088 1.1 skrll such a section already exists.
9089 1.1 skrll - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9090 1.1 skrll PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9091 1.1 skrll Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9092 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
9093 1.1 skrll _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9094 1.1 skrll char *name,
9095 1.1 skrll size_t size,
9096 1.1 skrll ufile_ptr filepos)
9097 1.1 skrll {
9098 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
9099 1.1 skrll char *threaded_name;
9100 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9101 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
9102 1.3 christos
9103 1.1 skrll /* Build the section name. */
9104 1.1 skrll
9105 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9106 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9107 1.1 skrll threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9108 1.1 skrll if (threaded_name == NULL)
9109 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9110 1.1 skrll memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9111 1.1 skrll
9112 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9113 1.1 skrll SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9114 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9115 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9116 1.1 skrll sect->size = size;
9117 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = filepos;
9118 1.8 christos sect->alignment_power = 2;
9119 1.8 christos
9120 1.8 christos return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9121 1.8 christos }
9122 1.8 christos
9123 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
9124 1.8 christos elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9125 1.8 christos size_t offs)
9126 1.8 christos {
9127 1.8 christos asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9128 1.8 christos SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9129 1.8 christos
9130 1.8 christos if (sect == NULL)
9131 1.8 christos return FALSE;
9132 1.8 christos sect->size = note->descsz - offs;
9133 1.8 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos + offs;
9134 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9135 1.1 skrll
9136 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9137 1.1 skrll }
9138 1.1 skrll
9139 1.1 skrll /* prstatus_t exists on:
9140 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
9141 1.1 skrll linux 2.[01] + glibc
9142 1.1 skrll unixware 4.2
9143 1.1 skrll */
9144 1.1 skrll
9145 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9146 1.1 skrll
9147 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9148 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9149 1.1 skrll {
9150 1.1 skrll size_t size;
9151 1.1 skrll int offset;
9152 1.1 skrll
9153 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9154 1.1 skrll {
9155 1.1 skrll prstatus_t prstat;
9156 1.1 skrll
9157 1.1 skrll size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9158 1.6 christos offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9159 1.6 christos memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9160 1.6 christos
9161 1.6 christos /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9162 1.1 skrll has already been set by another thread. */
9163 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9164 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9165 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9166 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9167 1.1 skrll
9168 1.1 skrll /* pr_who exists on:
9169 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
9170 1.6 christos unixware 4.2
9171 1.3 christos pr_who doesn't exist on:
9172 1.6 christos linux 2.[01]
9173 1.1 skrll */
9174 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9175 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9176 1.1 skrll #else
9177 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9178 1.1 skrll #endif
9179 1.1 skrll }
9180 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9181 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9182 1.1 skrll {
9183 1.1 skrll /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9184 1.1 skrll prstatus32_t prstat;
9185 1.1 skrll
9186 1.1 skrll size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9187 1.6 christos offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9188 1.6 christos memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9189 1.6 christos
9190 1.6 christos /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9191 1.1 skrll has already been set by another thread. */
9192 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9193 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9194 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9195 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9196 1.1 skrll
9197 1.1 skrll /* pr_who exists on:
9198 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
9199 1.6 christos unixware 4.2
9200 1.3 christos pr_who doesn't exist on:
9201 1.6 christos linux 2.[01]
9202 1.1 skrll */
9203 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9204 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9205 1.1 skrll #else
9206 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9207 1.1 skrll #endif
9208 1.1 skrll }
9209 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9210 1.1 skrll else
9211 1.1 skrll {
9212 1.1 skrll /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9213 1.1 skrll note size (ie. data object type). */
9214 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9215 1.1 skrll }
9216 1.1 skrll
9217 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9218 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9219 1.1 skrll size, note->descpos + offset);
9220 1.1 skrll }
9221 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9222 1.1 skrll
9223 1.1 skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9224 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9225 1.1 skrll elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9226 1.1 skrll char *name,
9227 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9228 1.1 skrll {
9229 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9230 1.1 skrll note->descsz, note->descpos);
9231 1.1 skrll }
9232 1.1 skrll
9233 1.1 skrll /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9234 1.1 skrll but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9235 1.1 skrll data structure apart. */
9236 1.1 skrll
9237 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9238 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9239 1.1 skrll {
9240 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9241 1.1 skrll }
9242 1.1 skrll
9243 1.1 skrll /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9244 1.1 skrll type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9245 1.1 skrll literally. */
9246 1.1 skrll
9247 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9248 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9249 1.3 christos {
9250 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9251 1.3 christos }
9252 1.3 christos
9253 1.3 christos /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9254 1.3 christos with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9255 1.3 christos contents literally. */
9256 1.3 christos
9257 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9258 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9259 1.1 skrll {
9260 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9261 1.1 skrll }
9262 1.1 skrll
9263 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9264 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9265 1.1 skrll {
9266 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9267 1.1 skrll }
9268 1.1 skrll
9269 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9270 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9271 1.3 christos {
9272 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9273 1.3 christos }
9274 1.3 christos
9275 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9276 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9277 1.3 christos {
9278 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9279 1.3 christos }
9280 1.3 christos
9281 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9282 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9283 1.3 christos {
9284 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9285 1.3 christos }
9286 1.3 christos
9287 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9288 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9289 1.3 christos {
9290 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9291 1.3 christos }
9292 1.3 christos
9293 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9294 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9295 1.3 christos {
9296 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9297 1.3 christos }
9298 1.3 christos
9299 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9300 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9301 1.3 christos {
9302 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9303 1.3 christos }
9304 1.3 christos
9305 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9306 1.5 christos elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9307 1.5 christos {
9308 1.5 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9309 1.5 christos }
9310 1.5 christos
9311 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9312 1.5 christos elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9313 1.5 christos {
9314 1.5 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9315 1.5 christos }
9316 1.5 christos
9317 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9318 1.5 christos elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9319 1.6 christos {
9320 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9321 1.6 christos }
9322 1.6 christos
9323 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9324 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9325 1.6 christos {
9326 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9327 1.6 christos }
9328 1.6 christos
9329 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9330 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9331 1.6 christos {
9332 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9333 1.6 christos }
9334 1.6 christos
9335 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9336 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9337 1.9 christos {
9338 1.9 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9339 1.9 christos }
9340 1.9 christos
9341 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
9342 1.9 christos elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9343 1.9 christos {
9344 1.9 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9345 1.9 christos }
9346 1.9 christos
9347 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
9348 1.9 christos elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9349 1.5 christos {
9350 1.5 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9351 1.5 christos }
9352 1.5 christos
9353 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9354 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9355 1.6 christos {
9356 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9357 1.6 christos }
9358 1.6 christos
9359 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9360 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9361 1.6 christos {
9362 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9363 1.6 christos }
9364 1.6 christos
9365 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9366 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9367 1.6 christos {
9368 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9369 1.6 christos }
9370 1.6 christos
9371 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9372 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9373 1.1 skrll {
9374 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9375 1.1 skrll }
9376 1.1 skrll
9377 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9378 1.1 skrll typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9379 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9380 1.1 skrll typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9381 1.1 skrll #endif
9382 1.1 skrll #endif
9383 1.1 skrll
9384 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9385 1.1 skrll typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9386 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9387 1.1 skrll typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9388 1.1 skrll #endif
9389 1.1 skrll #endif
9390 1.1 skrll
9391 1.1 skrll /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9392 1.1 skrll most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9393 1.1 skrll the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9394 1.3 christos
9395 1.1 skrll char *
9396 1.1 skrll _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9397 1.1 skrll {
9398 1.1 skrll char *dups;
9399 1.1 skrll char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9400 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9401 1.1 skrll
9402 1.3 christos if (end == NULL)
9403 1.1 skrll len = max;
9404 1.1 skrll else
9405 1.1 skrll len = end - start;
9406 1.1 skrll
9407 1.1 skrll dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9408 1.1 skrll if (dups == NULL)
9409 1.1 skrll return NULL;
9410 1.1 skrll
9411 1.1 skrll memcpy (dups, start, len);
9412 1.1 skrll dups[len] = '\0';
9413 1.1 skrll
9414 1.1 skrll return dups;
9415 1.1 skrll }
9416 1.1 skrll
9417 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9418 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9419 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9420 1.1 skrll {
9421 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9422 1.3 christos {
9423 1.6 christos elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9424 1.3 christos
9425 1.6 christos memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9426 1.1 skrll
9427 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9428 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9429 1.6 christos #endif
9430 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9431 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9432 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9433 1.1 skrll
9434 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9435 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9436 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9437 1.1 skrll }
9438 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9439 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9440 1.1 skrll {
9441 1.3 christos /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9442 1.6 christos elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9443 1.3 christos
9444 1.6 christos memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9445 1.1 skrll
9446 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9447 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9448 1.6 christos #endif
9449 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9450 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9451 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9452 1.1 skrll
9453 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9454 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9455 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9456 1.1 skrll }
9457 1.1 skrll #endif
9458 1.1 skrll
9459 1.1 skrll else
9460 1.1 skrll {
9461 1.1 skrll /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9462 1.1 skrll note size (ie. data object type). */
9463 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9464 1.1 skrll }
9465 1.1 skrll
9466 1.6 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9467 1.1 skrll onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9468 1.1 skrll implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9469 1.1 skrll
9470 1.1 skrll {
9471 1.1 skrll char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9472 1.1 skrll int n = strlen (command);
9473 1.1 skrll
9474 1.1 skrll if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9475 1.1 skrll command[n - 1] = '\0';
9476 1.1 skrll }
9477 1.1 skrll
9478 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9479 1.1 skrll }
9480 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9481 1.1 skrll
9482 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9483 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9484 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9485 1.1 skrll {
9486 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9487 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9488 1.1 skrll || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9489 1.1 skrll #endif
9490 1.1 skrll )
9491 1.6 christos {
9492 1.1 skrll pstatus_t pstat;
9493 1.1 skrll
9494 1.1 skrll memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9495 1.1 skrll
9496 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9497 1.1 skrll }
9498 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9499 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9500 1.1 skrll {
9501 1.6 christos /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9502 1.1 skrll pstatus32_t pstat;
9503 1.1 skrll
9504 1.1 skrll memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9505 1.1 skrll
9506 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9507 1.1 skrll }
9508 1.1 skrll #endif
9509 1.1 skrll /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9510 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9511 1.1 skrll NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9512 1.1 skrll
9513 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9514 1.1 skrll }
9515 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9516 1.1 skrll
9517 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9518 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9519 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9520 1.1 skrll {
9521 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9522 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
9523 1.1 skrll char *name;
9524 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9525 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
9526 1.1 skrll
9527 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9528 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9529 1.1 skrll && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9530 1.1 skrll #endif
9531 1.6 christos )
9532 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9533 1.3 christos
9534 1.6 christos memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9535 1.6 christos
9536 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9537 1.1 skrll /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9538 1.1 skrll another thread. */
9539 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9540 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9541 1.1 skrll
9542 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9543 1.1 skrll
9544 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9545 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9546 1.1 skrll name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9547 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9548 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9549 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
9550 1.1 skrll
9551 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9552 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9553 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9554 1.1 skrll
9555 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9556 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9557 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos
9558 1.1 skrll + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9559 1.1 skrll #endif
9560 1.1 skrll
9561 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9562 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9563 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9564 1.1 skrll #endif
9565 1.1 skrll
9566 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9567 1.1 skrll
9568 1.1 skrll if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9569 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9570 1.1 skrll
9571 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9572 1.1 skrll
9573 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9574 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9575 1.1 skrll name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9576 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9577 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9578 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
9579 1.1 skrll
9580 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9581 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9582 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9583 1.1 skrll
9584 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9585 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9586 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos
9587 1.1 skrll + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9588 1.1 skrll #endif
9589 1.1 skrll
9590 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9591 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9592 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9593 1.1 skrll #endif
9594 1.1 skrll
9595 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9596 1.1 skrll
9597 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9598 1.1 skrll }
9599 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9600 1.1 skrll
9601 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9602 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9603 1.1 skrll {
9604 1.1 skrll char buf[30];
9605 1.1 skrll char *name;
9606 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9607 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
9608 1.1 skrll int type;
9609 1.1 skrll int is_active_thread;
9610 1.1 skrll bfd_vma base_addr;
9611 1.1 skrll
9612 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz < 728)
9613 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9614 1.1 skrll
9615 1.1 skrll if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9616 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9617 1.1 skrll
9618 1.6 christos type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9619 1.1 skrll
9620 1.6 christos switch (type)
9621 1.1 skrll {
9622 1.6 christos case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9623 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9624 1.1 skrll /* process_info.pid */
9625 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9626 1.1 skrll /* process_info.signal */
9627 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9628 1.1 skrll break;
9629 1.1 skrll
9630 1.1 skrll case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9631 1.3 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9632 1.1 skrll /* thread_info.tid */
9633 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9634 1.1 skrll
9635 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9636 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9637 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9638 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9639 1.1 skrll
9640 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
9641 1.1 skrll
9642 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9643 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9644 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9645 1.1 skrll
9646 1.1 skrll /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9647 1.1 skrll sect->size = 716;
9648 1.1 skrll /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9649 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9650 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9651 1.1 skrll
9652 1.1 skrll /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9653 1.1 skrll is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9654 1.1 skrll
9655 1.1 skrll if (is_active_thread)
9656 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9657 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9658 1.1 skrll break;
9659 1.1 skrll
9660 1.1 skrll case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9661 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9662 1.3 christos /* module_info.base_address */
9663 1.1 skrll base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9664 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9665 1.1 skrll
9666 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9667 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9668 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9669 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9670 1.1 skrll
9671 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
9672 1.1 skrll
9673 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9674 1.1 skrll
9675 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9676 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9677 1.1 skrll
9678 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
9679 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9680 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9681 1.1 skrll break;
9682 1.1 skrll
9683 1.1 skrll default:
9684 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9685 1.1 skrll }
9686 1.1 skrll
9687 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9688 1.1 skrll }
9689 1.1 skrll
9690 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9691 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9692 1.1 skrll {
9693 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9694 1.1 skrll
9695 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
9696 1.1 skrll {
9697 1.1 skrll default:
9698 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9699 1.1 skrll
9700 1.1 skrll case NT_PRSTATUS:
9701 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9702 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9703 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9704 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9705 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9706 1.1 skrll #else
9707 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9708 1.1 skrll #endif
9709 1.1 skrll
9710 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9711 1.1 skrll case NT_PSTATUS:
9712 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9713 1.1 skrll #endif
9714 1.1 skrll
9715 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9716 1.1 skrll case NT_LWPSTATUS:
9717 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9718 1.1 skrll #endif
9719 1.1 skrll
9720 1.1 skrll case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9721 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9722 1.1 skrll
9723 1.1 skrll case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9724 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9725 1.1 skrll
9726 1.1 skrll case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9727 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
9728 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9729 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9730 1.3 christos else
9731 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9732 1.3 christos
9733 1.3 christos case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9734 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9735 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9736 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9737 1.1 skrll else
9738 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9739 1.1 skrll
9740 1.1 skrll case NT_PPC_VMX:
9741 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
9742 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9743 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9744 1.9 christos else
9745 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9746 1.1 skrll
9747 1.9 christos case NT_PPC_VSX:
9748 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
9749 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9750 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9751 1.9 christos else
9752 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9753 1.3 christos
9754 1.9 christos case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9755 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9756 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9757 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9758 1.9 christos else
9759 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9760 1.3 christos
9761 1.9 christos case NT_S390_TIMER:
9762 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9763 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9764 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9765 1.9 christos else
9766 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9767 1.3 christos
9768 1.9 christos case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9769 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9770 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9771 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9772 1.9 christos else
9773 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9774 1.3 christos
9775 1.9 christos case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9776 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9777 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9778 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9779 1.9 christos else
9780 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9781 1.3 christos
9782 1.9 christos case NT_S390_CTRS:
9783 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9784 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9785 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9786 1.9 christos else
9787 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9788 1.3 christos
9789 1.9 christos case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9790 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9791 1.5 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9792 1.5 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9793 1.9 christos else
9794 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9795 1.5 christos
9796 1.9 christos case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9797 1.5 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9798 1.5 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9799 1.5 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9800 1.9 christos else
9801 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9802 1.5 christos
9803 1.9 christos case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9804 1.5 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9805 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9806 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9807 1.9 christos else
9808 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9809 1.6 christos
9810 1.9 christos case NT_S390_TDB:
9811 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9812 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9813 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9814 1.6 christos else
9815 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9816 1.6 christos
9817 1.6 christos case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9818 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9819 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9820 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9821 1.6 christos else
9822 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9823 1.6 christos
9824 1.6 christos case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9825 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9826 1.9 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9827 1.9 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9828 1.9 christos else
9829 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9830 1.9 christos
9831 1.9 christos case NT_S390_GS_CB:
9832 1.9 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9833 1.9 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9834 1.9 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
9835 1.9 christos else
9836 1.9 christos return TRUE;
9837 1.9 christos
9838 1.9 christos case NT_S390_GS_BC:
9839 1.9 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9840 1.5 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9841 1.5 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
9842 1.5 christos else
9843 1.5 christos return TRUE;
9844 1.5 christos
9845 1.5 christos case NT_ARM_VFP:
9846 1.5 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9847 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9848 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9849 1.6 christos else
9850 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9851 1.6 christos
9852 1.6 christos case NT_ARM_TLS:
9853 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9854 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9855 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9856 1.6 christos else
9857 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9858 1.6 christos
9859 1.6 christos case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9860 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9861 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9862 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9863 1.6 christos else
9864 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9865 1.6 christos
9866 1.6 christos case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9867 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9868 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9869 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9870 1.1 skrll else
9871 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9872 1.1 skrll
9873 1.1 skrll case NT_PRPSINFO:
9874 1.1 skrll case NT_PSINFO:
9875 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9876 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9877 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9878 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9879 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9880 1.8 christos #else
9881 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9882 1.6 christos #endif
9883 1.6 christos
9884 1.6 christos case NT_AUXV:
9885 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
9886 1.6 christos
9887 1.6 christos case NT_FILE:
9888 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9889 1.7 christos note);
9890 1.1 skrll
9891 1.1 skrll case NT_SIGINFO:
9892 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9893 1.1 skrll note);
9894 1.1 skrll
9895 1.1 skrll }
9896 1.6 christos }
9897 1.6 christos
9898 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9899 1.6 christos elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9900 1.6 christos {
9901 1.6 christos struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9902 1.6 christos
9903 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == 0)
9904 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9905 1.6 christos
9906 1.6 christos build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9907 1.6 christos if (build_id == NULL)
9908 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9909 1.1 skrll
9910 1.1 skrll build_id->size = note->descsz;
9911 1.1 skrll memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9912 1.1 skrll abfd->build_id = build_id;
9913 1.1 skrll
9914 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9915 1.1 skrll }
9916 1.1 skrll
9917 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9918 1.1 skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9919 1.1 skrll {
9920 1.9 christos switch (note->type)
9921 1.9 christos {
9922 1.9 christos default:
9923 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9924 1.1 skrll
9925 1.1 skrll case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
9926 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
9927 1.1 skrll
9928 1.1 skrll case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9929 1.5 christos return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9930 1.5 christos }
9931 1.5 christos }
9932 1.5 christos
9933 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9934 1.5 christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9935 1.5 christos {
9936 1.5 christos struct sdt_note *cur =
9937 1.5 christos (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9938 1.5 christos + note->descsz);
9939 1.5 christos
9940 1.5 christos cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9941 1.5 christos cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9942 1.5 christos memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9943 1.5 christos
9944 1.5 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9945 1.5 christos
9946 1.5 christos return TRUE;
9947 1.5 christos }
9948 1.5 christos
9949 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9950 1.5 christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9951 1.5 christos {
9952 1.5 christos switch (note->type)
9953 1.5 christos {
9954 1.5 christos case NT_STAPSDT:
9955 1.5 christos return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9956 1.5 christos
9957 1.5 christos default:
9958 1.7 christos return TRUE;
9959 1.7 christos }
9960 1.7 christos }
9961 1.7 christos
9962 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
9963 1.9 christos elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9964 1.9 christos {
9965 1.9 christos size_t offset;
9966 1.9 christos
9967 1.9 christos switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
9968 1.9 christos {
9969 1.9 christos case ELFCLASS32:
9970 1.9 christos if (note->descsz < 108)
9971 1.9 christos return FALSE;
9972 1.9 christos break;
9973 1.9 christos
9974 1.9 christos case ELFCLASS64:
9975 1.9 christos if (note->descsz < 120)
9976 1.9 christos return FALSE;
9977 1.9 christos break;
9978 1.9 christos
9979 1.7 christos default:
9980 1.7 christos return FALSE;
9981 1.9 christos }
9982 1.7 christos
9983 1.7 christos /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9984 1.7 christos if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9985 1.9 christos return FALSE;
9986 1.9 christos
9987 1.9 christos offset = 4;
9988 1.7 christos
9989 1.7 christos /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
9990 1.7 christos if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
9991 1.7 christos offset += 4;
9992 1.7 christos else
9993 1.7 christos {
9994 1.7 christos offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
9995 1.7 christos offset += 8;
9996 1.7 christos }
9997 1.7 christos
9998 1.7 christos /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
9999 1.7 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10000 1.7 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10001 1.9 christos offset += 17;
10002 1.9 christos
10003 1.9 christos /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10004 1.9 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10005 1.9 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10006 1.9 christos offset += 81;
10007 1.9 christos
10008 1.9 christos /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10009 1.9 christos offset += 2;
10010 1.9 christos
10011 1.9 christos /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10012 1.7 christos if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10013 1.7 christos return TRUE;
10014 1.7 christos
10015 1.7 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10016 1.7 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10017 1.7 christos
10018 1.7 christos return TRUE;
10019 1.7 christos }
10020 1.7 christos
10021 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
10022 1.7 christos elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10023 1.9 christos {
10024 1.9 christos size_t offset;
10025 1.9 christos size_t size;
10026 1.9 christos size_t min_size;
10027 1.9 christos
10028 1.9 christos /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10029 1.9 christos Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10030 1.7 christos switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10031 1.7 christos {
10032 1.9 christos case ELFCLASS32:
10033 1.9 christos offset = 4 + 4;
10034 1.9 christos min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10035 1.7 christos break;
10036 1.7 christos
10037 1.7 christos case ELFCLASS64:
10038 1.7 christos offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10039 1.7 christos min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10040 1.7 christos break;
10041 1.9 christos
10042 1.9 christos default:
10043 1.9 christos return FALSE;
10044 1.9 christos }
10045 1.9 christos
10046 1.9 christos if (note->descsz < min_size)
10047 1.9 christos return FALSE;
10048 1.7 christos
10049 1.9 christos /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10050 1.9 christos if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10051 1.9 christos return FALSE;
10052 1.9 christos
10053 1.9 christos /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10054 1.9 christos /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10055 1.7 christos if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10056 1.9 christos {
10057 1.9 christos size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10058 1.9 christos offset += 4 * 2;
10059 1.9 christos }
10060 1.7 christos else
10061 1.9 christos {
10062 1.7 christos size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10063 1.7 christos offset += 8 * 2;
10064 1.9 christos }
10065 1.7 christos
10066 1.7 christos /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10067 1.7 christos offset += 4;
10068 1.7 christos
10069 1.7 christos /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10070 1.9 christos if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10071 1.7 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10072 1.7 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10073 1.7 christos offset += 4;
10074 1.7 christos
10075 1.9 christos /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10076 1.9 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10077 1.7 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10078 1.7 christos offset += 4;
10079 1.9 christos
10080 1.9 christos /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10081 1.9 christos if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10082 1.9 christos offset += 4;
10083 1.7 christos
10084 1.7 christos /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10085 1.7 christos if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10086 1.7 christos return FALSE;
10087 1.7 christos
10088 1.7 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10089 1.7 christos return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10090 1.7 christos size, note->descpos + offset);
10091 1.9 christos }
10092 1.9 christos
10093 1.7 christos static bfd_boolean
10094 1.7 christos elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10095 1.7 christos {
10096 1.9 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10097 1.9 christos
10098 1.9 christos switch (note->type)
10099 1.7 christos {
10100 1.7 christos case NT_PRSTATUS:
10101 1.7 christos if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10102 1.7 christos if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10103 1.7 christos return TRUE;
10104 1.7 christos return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10105 1.7 christos
10106 1.7 christos case NT_FPREGSET:
10107 1.7 christos return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10108 1.7 christos
10109 1.7 christos case NT_PRPSINFO:
10110 1.7 christos return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10111 1.7 christos
10112 1.7 christos case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10113 1.9 christos if (note->namesz == 8)
10114 1.9 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10115 1.9 christos else
10116 1.9 christos return TRUE;
10117 1.9 christos
10118 1.9 christos case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10119 1.9 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10120 1.9 christos note);
10121 1.9 christos
10122 1.9 christos case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10123 1.9 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10124 1.9 christos note);
10125 1.7 christos
10126 1.8 christos case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10127 1.7 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10128 1.7 christos note);
10129 1.7 christos
10130 1.7 christos case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10131 1.7 christos return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10132 1.7 christos
10133 1.7 christos case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10134 1.9 christos if (note->namesz == 8)
10135 1.9 christos return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10136 1.9 christos else
10137 1.9 christos return TRUE;
10138 1.9 christos
10139 1.9 christos case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10140 1.9 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10141 1.7 christos note);
10142 1.7 christos
10143 1.7 christos case NT_ARM_VFP:
10144 1.7 christos return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10145 1.7 christos
10146 1.7 christos default:
10147 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10148 1.1 skrll }
10149 1.1 skrll }
10150 1.1 skrll
10151 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10152 1.1 skrll elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10153 1.1 skrll {
10154 1.1 skrll char *cp;
10155 1.1 skrll
10156 1.1 skrll cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10157 1.1 skrll if (cp != NULL)
10158 1.1 skrll {
10159 1.1 skrll *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10160 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10161 1.1 skrll }
10162 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10163 1.9 christos }
10164 1.9 christos
10165 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
10166 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10167 1.6 christos {
10168 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10169 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10170 1.1 skrll
10171 1.6 christos /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10172 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10173 1.1 skrll = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10174 1.1 skrll
10175 1.6 christos /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10176 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10177 1.1 skrll = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10178 1.1 skrll
10179 1.1 skrll /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10180 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10181 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10182 1.8 christos
10183 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10184 1.1 skrll note);
10185 1.1 skrll }
10186 1.1 skrll
10187 1.1 skrll
10188 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10189 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10190 1.1 skrll {
10191 1.8 christos int lwp;
10192 1.1 skrll
10193 1.8 christos if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10194 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10195 1.1 skrll
10196 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
10197 1.1 skrll {
10198 1.8 christos case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO:
10199 1.8 christos /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10200 1.8 christos find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10201 1.8 christos since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10202 1.8 christos creates a core file. */
10203 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10204 1.8 christos
10205 1.8 christos case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV:
10206 1.1 skrll /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10207 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10208 1.8 christos
10209 1.1 skrll default:
10210 1.1 skrll break;
10211 1.1 skrll }
10212 1.1 skrll
10213 1.1 skrll /* As of March 2017 there are no other machine-independent notes
10214 1.1 skrll defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10215 1.1 skrll than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10216 1.1 skrll understand it. */
10217 1.1 skrll
10218 1.1 skrll if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10219 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10220 1.1 skrll
10221 1.1 skrll
10222 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10223 1.1 skrll {
10224 1.1 skrll /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10225 1.1 skrll PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10226 1.1 skrll
10227 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_alpha:
10228 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_sparc:
10229 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
10230 1.1 skrll {
10231 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10232 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10233 1.1 skrll
10234 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10235 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10236 1.4 uwe
10237 1.4 uwe default:
10238 1.4 uwe return TRUE;
10239 1.4 uwe }
10240 1.4 uwe
10241 1.4 uwe /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10242 1.4 uwe There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10243 1.4 uwe structure which lacks GBR. */
10244 1.4 uwe
10245 1.4 uwe case bfd_arch_sh:
10246 1.4 uwe switch (note->type)
10247 1.4 uwe {
10248 1.4 uwe case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10249 1.4 uwe return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10250 1.4 uwe
10251 1.4 uwe case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
10252 1.4 uwe return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10253 1.1 skrll
10254 1.1 skrll default:
10255 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10256 1.1 skrll }
10257 1.1 skrll
10258 1.1 skrll /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10259 1.1 skrll PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10260 1.1 skrll
10261 1.1 skrll default:
10262 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
10263 1.1 skrll {
10264 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10265 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10266 1.1 skrll
10267 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10268 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10269 1.1 skrll
10270 1.1 skrll default:
10271 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10272 1.1 skrll }
10273 1.3 christos }
10274 1.3 christos /* NOTREACHED */
10275 1.9 christos }
10276 1.9 christos
10277 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
10278 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10279 1.6 christos {
10280 1.3 christos if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10281 1.3 christos return FALSE;
10282 1.3 christos
10283 1.6 christos /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10284 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10285 1.3 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10286 1.3 christos
10287 1.6 christos /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10288 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10289 1.3 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10290 1.3 christos
10291 1.3 christos /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10292 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10293 1.3 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10294 1.3 christos
10295 1.3 christos return TRUE;
10296 1.3 christos }
10297 1.3 christos
10298 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
10299 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10300 1.3 christos {
10301 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10302 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10303 1.3 christos
10304 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10305 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10306 1.3 christos
10307 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10308 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10309 1.8 christos
10310 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10311 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10312 1.3 christos
10313 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10314 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10315 1.3 christos
10316 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10317 1.3 christos {
10318 1.3 christos asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10319 1.3 christos SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10320 1.3 christos
10321 1.3 christos if (sect == NULL)
10322 1.3 christos return FALSE;
10323 1.3 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
10324 1.3 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10325 1.3 christos sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10326 1.3 christos
10327 1.3 christos return TRUE;
10328 1.3 christos }
10329 1.1 skrll
10330 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10331 1.1 skrll }
10332 1.1 skrll
10333 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10334 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10335 1.1 skrll {
10336 1.1 skrll void *ddata = note->descdata;
10337 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
10338 1.9 christos char *name;
10339 1.9 christos asection *sect;
10340 1.9 christos short sig;
10341 1.1 skrll unsigned flags;
10342 1.6 christos
10343 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz < 16)
10344 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10345 1.1 skrll
10346 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10347 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10348 1.1 skrll
10349 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10350 1.1 skrll *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10351 1.1 skrll
10352 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10353 1.6 christos flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10354 1.6 christos
10355 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10356 1.1 skrll if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10357 1.1 skrll {
10358 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10359 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10360 1.1 skrll }
10361 1.6 christos
10362 1.1 skrll /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10363 1.1 skrll do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10364 1.1 skrll thread just in case. */
10365 1.1 skrll if (flags & 0x00000080)
10366 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10367 1.1 skrll
10368 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10369 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10370 1.1 skrll
10371 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10372 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
10373 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10374 1.1 skrll strcpy (name, buf);
10375 1.9 christos
10376 1.9 christos sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10377 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
10378 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10379 1.1 skrll
10380 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
10381 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10382 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
10383 1.1 skrll
10384 1.1 skrll return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10385 1.1 skrll }
10386 1.1 skrll
10387 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10388 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10389 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10390 1.1 skrll long tid,
10391 1.1 skrll char *base)
10392 1.1 skrll {
10393 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
10394 1.1 skrll char *name;
10395 1.3 christos asection *sect;
10396 1.1 skrll
10397 1.1 skrll /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10398 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10399 1.1 skrll
10400 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10401 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
10402 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10403 1.1 skrll strcpy (name, buf);
10404 1.9 christos
10405 1.9 christos sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10406 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
10407 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10408 1.1 skrll
10409 1.6 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
10410 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10411 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
10412 1.1 skrll
10413 1.1 skrll /* This is the current thread. */
10414 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10415 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10416 1.1 skrll
10417 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10418 1.1 skrll }
10419 1.1 skrll
10420 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10421 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10422 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10423 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10424 1.1 skrll
10425 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10426 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10427 1.1 skrll {
10428 1.1 skrll /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10429 1.1 skrll tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10430 1.1 skrll function. */
10431 1.1 skrll static long tid = 1;
10432 1.1 skrll
10433 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
10434 1.1 skrll {
10435 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10436 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10437 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10438 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10439 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10440 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10441 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10442 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10443 1.1 skrll default:
10444 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10445 1.1 skrll }
10446 1.1 skrll }
10447 1.1 skrll
10448 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10449 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10450 1.1 skrll {
10451 1.1 skrll char *name;
10452 1.3 christos asection *sect;
10453 1.1 skrll size_t len;
10454 1.1 skrll
10455 1.1 skrll /* Use note name as section name. */
10456 1.1 skrll len = note->namesz;
10457 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10458 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
10459 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10460 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10461 1.1 skrll name[len - 1] = '\0';
10462 1.9 christos
10463 1.9 christos sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10464 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
10465 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10466 1.1 skrll
10467 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
10468 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10469 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 1;
10470 1.1 skrll
10471 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10472 1.1 skrll }
10473 1.1 skrll
10474 1.1 skrll /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10475 1.1 skrll
10476 1.1 skrll Inputs:
10477 1.1 skrll buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10478 1.1 skrll name of note
10479 1.1 skrll type of note
10480 1.1 skrll data for note
10481 1.1 skrll size of data for note
10482 1.1 skrll
10483 1.1 skrll Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10484 1.1 skrll for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10485 1.1 skrll that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10486 1.1 skrll 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10487 1.1 skrll
10488 1.1 skrll Return:
10489 1.1 skrll Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10490 1.1 skrll
10491 1.1 skrll char *
10492 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10493 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10494 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10495 1.1 skrll const char *name,
10496 1.1 skrll int type,
10497 1.1 skrll const void *input,
10498 1.1 skrll int size)
10499 1.1 skrll {
10500 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10501 1.1 skrll size_t namesz;
10502 1.1 skrll size_t newspace;
10503 1.1 skrll char *dest;
10504 1.1 skrll
10505 1.1 skrll namesz = 0;
10506 1.3 christos if (name != NULL)
10507 1.1 skrll namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10508 1.1 skrll
10509 1.1 skrll newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10510 1.1 skrll
10511 1.1 skrll buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10512 1.1 skrll if (buf == NULL)
10513 1.1 skrll return buf;
10514 1.1 skrll dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10515 1.1 skrll *bufsiz += newspace;
10516 1.1 skrll xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10517 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10518 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10519 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10520 1.1 skrll dest = xnp->name;
10521 1.1 skrll if (name != NULL)
10522 1.1 skrll {
10523 1.1 skrll memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10524 1.1 skrll dest += namesz;
10525 1.1 skrll while (namesz & 3)
10526 1.1 skrll {
10527 1.1 skrll *dest++ = '\0';
10528 1.1 skrll ++namesz;
10529 1.1 skrll }
10530 1.1 skrll }
10531 1.1 skrll memcpy (dest, input, size);
10532 1.1 skrll dest += size;
10533 1.1 skrll while (size & 3)
10534 1.1 skrll {
10535 1.1 skrll *dest++ = '\0';
10536 1.13 christos ++size;
10537 1.13 christos }
10538 1.13 christos return buf;
10539 1.13 christos }
10540 1.13 christos
10541 1.13 christos /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
10542 1.13 christos possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
10543 1.13 christos have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
10544 1.13 christos necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
10545 1.13 christos representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
10546 1.13 christos be NULL terminated.
10547 1.13 christos gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
10548 1.13 christos diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
10549 1.13 christos the finer control available with later versions.
10550 1.13 christos gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
10551 1.13 christos gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
10552 1.13 christos unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
10553 1.1 skrll (*) Depending on your system header files! */
10554 1.1 skrll #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10555 1.1 skrll # pragma GCC diagnostic push
10556 1.1 skrll # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
10557 1.1 skrll #endif
10558 1.1 skrll char *
10559 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10560 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10561 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10562 1.1 skrll const char *fname,
10563 1.1 skrll const char *psargs)
10564 1.1 skrll {
10565 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10566 1.1 skrll
10567 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10568 1.1 skrll {
10569 1.1 skrll char *ret;
10570 1.1 skrll ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10571 1.5 christos NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10572 1.13 christos if (ret != NULL)
10573 1.1 skrll return ret;
10574 1.1 skrll }
10575 1.13 christos
10576 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10577 1.1 skrll # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10578 1.13 christos if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10579 1.1 skrll {
10580 1.1 skrll # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10581 1.13 christos psinfo32_t data;
10582 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10583 1.1 skrll # else
10584 1.1 skrll prpsinfo32_t data;
10585 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10586 1.1 skrll # endif
10587 1.5 christos
10588 1.1 skrll memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10589 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10590 1.13 christos strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10591 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10592 1.13 christos "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10593 1.1 skrll }
10594 1.1 skrll else
10595 1.13 christos # endif
10596 1.1 skrll {
10597 1.1 skrll # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10598 1.13 christos psinfo_t data;
10599 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10600 1.1 skrll # else
10601 1.1 skrll prpsinfo_t data;
10602 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10603 1.1 skrll # endif
10604 1.5 christos
10605 1.1 skrll memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10606 1.5 christos strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10607 1.5 christos strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10608 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10609 1.5 christos "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10610 1.1 skrll }
10611 1.13 christos #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10612 1.13 christos
10613 1.13 christos free (buf);
10614 1.1 skrll return NULL;
10615 1.1 skrll }
10616 1.6 christos #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10617 1.6 christos # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
10618 1.6 christos #endif
10619 1.6 christos
10620 1.9 christos char *
10621 1.9 christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10622 1.9 christos (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10623 1.9 christos const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10624 1.9 christos {
10625 1.9 christos if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10626 1.9 christos {
10627 1.9 christos struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10628 1.9 christos
10629 1.9 christos swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10630 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10631 1.6 christos &data, sizeof (data));
10632 1.9 christos }
10633 1.9 christos else
10634 1.9 christos {
10635 1.9 christos struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10636 1.6 christos
10637 1.6 christos swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10638 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10639 1.6 christos &data, sizeof (data));
10640 1.6 christos }
10641 1.6 christos }
10642 1.6 christos
10643 1.9 christos char *
10644 1.9 christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10645 1.9 christos (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10646 1.6 christos const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10647 1.9 christos {
10648 1.9 christos if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10649 1.9 christos {
10650 1.9 christos struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10651 1.9 christos
10652 1.9 christos swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10653 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10654 1.9 christos "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10655 1.9 christos }
10656 1.9 christos else
10657 1.9 christos {
10658 1.9 christos struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10659 1.6 christos
10660 1.6 christos swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10661 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10662 1.1 skrll "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10663 1.1 skrll }
10664 1.1 skrll }
10665 1.1 skrll
10666 1.1 skrll char *
10667 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10668 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10669 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10670 1.1 skrll long pid,
10671 1.1 skrll int cursig,
10672 1.1 skrll const void *gregs)
10673 1.1 skrll {
10674 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10675 1.1 skrll
10676 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10677 1.1 skrll {
10678 1.1 skrll char *ret;
10679 1.1 skrll ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10680 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS,
10681 1.5 christos pid, cursig, gregs);
10682 1.1 skrll if (ret != NULL)
10683 1.1 skrll return ret;
10684 1.1 skrll }
10685 1.1 skrll
10686 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10687 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10688 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10689 1.1 skrll {
10690 1.1 skrll prstatus32_t prstat;
10691 1.5 christos
10692 1.1 skrll memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10693 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10694 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10695 1.1 skrll memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10696 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10697 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10698 1.1 skrll }
10699 1.1 skrll else
10700 1.1 skrll #endif
10701 1.1 skrll {
10702 1.1 skrll prstatus_t prstat;
10703 1.5 christos
10704 1.1 skrll memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10705 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10706 1.5 christos prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10707 1.5 christos memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10708 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10709 1.5 christos NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10710 1.1 skrll }
10711 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10712 1.1 skrll
10713 1.1 skrll free (buf);
10714 1.1 skrll return NULL;
10715 1.1 skrll }
10716 1.1 skrll
10717 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10718 1.1 skrll char *
10719 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10720 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10721 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10722 1.1 skrll long pid,
10723 1.1 skrll int cursig,
10724 1.1 skrll const void *gregs)
10725 1.1 skrll {
10726 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10727 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
10728 1.6 christos
10729 1.1 skrll memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10730 1.1 skrll lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10731 1.1 skrll lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10732 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10733 1.1 skrll memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10734 1.1 skrll #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10735 1.1 skrll #if !defined(gregs)
10736 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10737 1.1 skrll gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10738 1.1 skrll #else
10739 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10740 1.1 skrll gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10741 1.1 skrll #endif
10742 1.1 skrll #endif
10743 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10744 1.1 skrll NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10745 1.1 skrll }
10746 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10747 1.1 skrll
10748 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10749 1.1 skrll char *
10750 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10751 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10752 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10753 1.1 skrll long pid,
10754 1.1 skrll int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10755 1.1 skrll const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10756 1.1 skrll {
10757 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
10758 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10759 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10760 1.1 skrll
10761 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10762 1.1 skrll {
10763 1.1 skrll pstatus32_t pstat;
10764 1.1 skrll
10765 1.1 skrll memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10766 1.1 skrll pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10767 1.1 skrll buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10768 1.1 skrll NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10769 1.1 skrll return buf;
10770 1.1 skrll }
10771 1.1 skrll else
10772 1.1 skrll #endif
10773 1.1 skrll {
10774 1.1 skrll pstatus_t pstat;
10775 1.1 skrll
10776 1.1 skrll memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10777 1.1 skrll pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10778 1.1 skrll buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10779 1.1 skrll NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10780 1.1 skrll return buf;
10781 1.1 skrll }
10782 1.1 skrll }
10783 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10784 1.1 skrll
10785 1.1 skrll char *
10786 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10787 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10788 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10789 1.1 skrll const void *fpregs,
10790 1.1 skrll int size)
10791 1.1 skrll {
10792 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
10793 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10794 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10795 1.1 skrll }
10796 1.1 skrll
10797 1.1 skrll char *
10798 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10799 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10800 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10801 1.1 skrll const void *xfpregs,
10802 1.1 skrll int size)
10803 1.1 skrll {
10804 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
10805 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10806 1.3 christos note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10807 1.3 christos }
10808 1.6 christos
10809 1.6 christos char *
10810 1.6 christos elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10811 1.6 christos const void *xfpregs, int size)
10812 1.6 christos {
10813 1.3 christos char *note_name;
10814 1.3 christos if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10815 1.3 christos note_name = "FreeBSD";
10816 1.3 christos else
10817 1.3 christos note_name = "LINUX";
10818 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10819 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10820 1.1 skrll }
10821 1.1 skrll
10822 1.1 skrll char *
10823 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10824 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10825 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10826 1.1 skrll const void *ppc_vmx,
10827 1.1 skrll int size)
10828 1.1 skrll {
10829 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
10830 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10831 1.9 christos note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
10832 1.9 christos }
10833 1.9 christos
10834 1.9 christos char *
10835 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
10836 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10837 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10838 1.9 christos const void *ppc_vsx,
10839 1.1 skrll int size)
10840 1.1 skrll {
10841 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10842 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10843 1.3 christos note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
10844 1.3 christos }
10845 1.3 christos
10846 1.3 christos static char *
10847 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
10848 1.3 christos char *buf,
10849 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10850 1.9 christos const void *s390_high_gprs,
10851 1.3 christos int size)
10852 1.3 christos {
10853 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10854 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10855 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
10856 1.9 christos s390_high_gprs, size);
10857 1.9 christos }
10858 1.9 christos
10859 1.9 christos char *
10860 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
10861 1.3 christos char *buf,
10862 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10863 1.9 christos const void *s390_timer,
10864 1.3 christos int size)
10865 1.3 christos {
10866 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10867 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10868 1.9 christos note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
10869 1.9 christos }
10870 1.9 christos
10871 1.9 christos char *
10872 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
10873 1.3 christos char *buf,
10874 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10875 1.9 christos const void *s390_todcmp,
10876 1.3 christos int size)
10877 1.3 christos {
10878 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10879 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10880 1.9 christos note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
10881 1.9 christos }
10882 1.9 christos
10883 1.9 christos char *
10884 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
10885 1.3 christos char *buf,
10886 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10887 1.9 christos const void *s390_todpreg,
10888 1.3 christos int size)
10889 1.3 christos {
10890 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10891 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10892 1.9 christos note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
10893 1.9 christos }
10894 1.9 christos
10895 1.9 christos char *
10896 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
10897 1.3 christos char *buf,
10898 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10899 1.9 christos const void *s390_ctrs,
10900 1.3 christos int size)
10901 1.3 christos {
10902 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10903 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10904 1.9 christos note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
10905 1.9 christos }
10906 1.9 christos
10907 1.9 christos char *
10908 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
10909 1.3 christos char *buf,
10910 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10911 1.9 christos const void *s390_prefix,
10912 1.3 christos int size)
10913 1.3 christos {
10914 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
10915 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10916 1.5 christos note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
10917 1.5 christos }
10918 1.5 christos
10919 1.5 christos char *
10920 1.5 christos elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
10921 1.5 christos char *buf,
10922 1.5 christos int *bufsiz,
10923 1.9 christos const void *s390_last_break,
10924 1.5 christos int size)
10925 1.5 christos {
10926 1.5 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10927 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10928 1.5 christos note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
10929 1.5 christos s390_last_break, size);
10930 1.5 christos }
10931 1.5 christos
10932 1.5 christos char *
10933 1.5 christos elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10934 1.5 christos char *buf,
10935 1.5 christos int *bufsiz,
10936 1.9 christos const void *s390_system_call,
10937 1.5 christos int size)
10938 1.5 christos {
10939 1.5 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10940 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10941 1.6 christos note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10942 1.6 christos s390_system_call, size);
10943 1.6 christos }
10944 1.6 christos
10945 1.6 christos char *
10946 1.6 christos elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10947 1.6 christos char *buf,
10948 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10949 1.9 christos const void *s390_tdb,
10950 1.6 christos int size)
10951 1.6 christos {
10952 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10953 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10954 1.6 christos note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10955 1.6 christos }
10956 1.6 christos
10957 1.6 christos char *
10958 1.6 christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10959 1.6 christos char *buf,
10960 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10961 1.6 christos const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10962 1.6 christos int size)
10963 1.6 christos {
10964 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10965 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10966 1.6 christos note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10967 1.6 christos }
10968 1.6 christos
10969 1.6 christos char *
10970 1.6 christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10971 1.6 christos char *buf,
10972 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10973 1.6 christos const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10974 1.6 christos int size)
10975 1.6 christos {
10976 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10977 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10978 1.9 christos note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10979 1.9 christos s390_vxrs_high, size);
10980 1.9 christos }
10981 1.9 christos
10982 1.9 christos char *
10983 1.9 christos elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
10984 1.9 christos char *buf,
10985 1.9 christos int *bufsiz,
10986 1.9 christos const void *s390_gs_cb,
10987 1.9 christos int size)
10988 1.9 christos {
10989 1.9 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10990 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10991 1.9 christos note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
10992 1.9 christos s390_gs_cb, size);
10993 1.9 christos }
10994 1.9 christos
10995 1.9 christos char *
10996 1.9 christos elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
10997 1.9 christos char *buf,
10998 1.9 christos int *bufsiz,
10999 1.9 christos const void *s390_gs_bc,
11000 1.9 christos int size)
11001 1.9 christos {
11002 1.9 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
11003 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11004 1.5 christos note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11005 1.5 christos s390_gs_bc, size);
11006 1.5 christos }
11007 1.5 christos
11008 1.5 christos char *
11009 1.5 christos elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11010 1.5 christos char *buf,
11011 1.5 christos int *bufsiz,
11012 1.5 christos const void *arm_vfp,
11013 1.5 christos int size)
11014 1.5 christos {
11015 1.5 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
11016 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11017 1.6 christos note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11018 1.6 christos }
11019 1.6 christos
11020 1.6 christos char *
11021 1.6 christos elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11022 1.6 christos char *buf,
11023 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
11024 1.6 christos const void *aarch_tls,
11025 1.6 christos int size)
11026 1.6 christos {
11027 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
11028 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11029 1.6 christos note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11030 1.6 christos }
11031 1.6 christos
11032 1.6 christos char *
11033 1.6 christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11034 1.6 christos char *buf,
11035 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
11036 1.6 christos const void *aarch_hw_break,
11037 1.6 christos int size)
11038 1.6 christos {
11039 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
11040 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11041 1.6 christos note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11042 1.6 christos }
11043 1.6 christos
11044 1.6 christos char *
11045 1.6 christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11046 1.6 christos char *buf,
11047 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
11048 1.6 christos const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11049 1.6 christos int size)
11050 1.6 christos {
11051 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
11052 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11053 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11054 1.1 skrll }
11055 1.1 skrll
11056 1.1 skrll char *
11057 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11058 1.1 skrll char *buf,
11059 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
11060 1.1 skrll const char *section,
11061 1.1 skrll const void *data,
11062 1.1 skrll int size)
11063 1.3 christos {
11064 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11065 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11066 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11067 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11068 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11069 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11070 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11071 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11072 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11073 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11074 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11075 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11076 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11077 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11078 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11079 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11080 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11081 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11082 1.5 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11083 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11084 1.5 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11085 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11086 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11087 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11088 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11089 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11090 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11091 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11092 1.9 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11093 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11094 1.9 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11095 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11096 1.5 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11097 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11098 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11099 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11100 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11101 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11102 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11103 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11104 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11105 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11106 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11107 1.9 christos return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11108 1.9 christos return NULL;
11109 1.1 skrll }
11110 1.1 skrll
11111 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
11112 1.9 christos elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11113 1.9 christos size_t align)
11114 1.9 christos {
11115 1.9 christos char *p;
11116 1.9 christos
11117 1.9 christos /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11118 1.13 christos gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11119 1.13 christos bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11120 1.9 christos align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11121 1.1 skrll if (align < 4)
11122 1.1 skrll align = 4;
11123 1.1 skrll if (align != 4 && align != 8)
11124 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
11125 1.1 skrll
11126 1.1 skrll p = buf;
11127 1.1 skrll while (p < buf + size)
11128 1.1 skrll {
11129 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11130 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note in;
11131 1.1 skrll
11132 1.1 skrll if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11133 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
11134 1.1 skrll
11135 1.1 skrll in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11136 1.1 skrll
11137 1.1 skrll in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11138 1.9 christos in.namedata = xnp->name;
11139 1.1 skrll if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11140 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
11141 1.1 skrll
11142 1.1 skrll in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11143 1.1 skrll in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11144 1.1 skrll in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11145 1.1 skrll if (in.descsz != 0
11146 1.9 christos && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11147 1.1 skrll || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11148 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
11149 1.1 skrll
11150 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11151 1.6 christos {
11152 1.6 christos default:
11153 1.6 christos return TRUE;
11154 1.1 skrll
11155 1.6 christos case bfd_core:
11156 1.6 christos {
11157 1.6 christos #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11158 1.1 skrll struct
11159 1.6 christos {
11160 1.3 christos const char * string;
11161 1.6 christos size_t len;
11162 1.7 christos bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11163 1.6 christos }
11164 1.6 christos grokers[] =
11165 1.6 christos {
11166 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11167 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11168 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11169 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11170 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11171 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11172 1.6 christos };
11173 1.6 christos #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11174 1.6 christos int i;
11175 1.6 christos
11176 1.6 christos for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11177 1.6 christos {
11178 1.6 christos if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11179 1.6 christos && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11180 1.6 christos grokers[i].len) == 0)
11181 1.6 christos {
11182 1.6 christos if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11183 1.6 christos return FALSE;
11184 1.1 skrll break;
11185 1.1 skrll }
11186 1.1 skrll }
11187 1.1 skrll break;
11188 1.1 skrll }
11189 1.1 skrll
11190 1.1 skrll case bfd_object:
11191 1.5 christos if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11192 1.5 christos {
11193 1.5 christos if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11194 1.5 christos return FALSE;
11195 1.5 christos }
11196 1.5 christos else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11197 1.1 skrll && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11198 1.1 skrll {
11199 1.1 skrll if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11200 1.9 christos return FALSE;
11201 1.1 skrll }
11202 1.1 skrll break;
11203 1.1 skrll }
11204 1.1 skrll
11205 1.1 skrll p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
11206 1.1 skrll }
11207 1.9 christos
11208 1.9 christos return TRUE;
11209 1.1 skrll }
11210 1.1 skrll
11211 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
11212 1.9 christos elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
11213 1.1 skrll size_t align)
11214 1.1 skrll {
11215 1.1 skrll char *buf;
11216 1.1 skrll
11217 1.1 skrll if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11218 1.6 christos return TRUE;
11219 1.1 skrll
11220 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11221 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
11222 1.6 christos
11223 1.6 christos buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11224 1.6 christos if (buf == NULL)
11225 1.6 christos return FALSE;
11226 1.1 skrll
11227 1.9 christos /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11228 1.1 skrll 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11229 1.1 skrll buf[size] = 0;
11230 1.1 skrll
11231 1.1 skrll if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11232 1.1 skrll || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
11233 1.1 skrll {
11234 1.1 skrll free (buf);
11235 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
11236 1.1 skrll }
11237 1.1 skrll
11238 1.1 skrll free (buf);
11239 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
11240 1.1 skrll }
11241 1.1 skrll
11242 1.1 skrll /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11244 1.1 skrll
11245 1.1 skrll /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11246 1.1 skrll copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11247 1.1 skrll occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11248 1.1 skrll
11249 1.1 skrll long
11250 1.1 skrll bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11251 1.1 skrll {
11252 1.1 skrll if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11253 1.1 skrll {
11254 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11255 1.1 skrll return -1;
11256 1.1 skrll }
11257 1.1 skrll
11258 1.1 skrll return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11259 1.1 skrll }
11260 1.1 skrll
11261 1.1 skrll /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11262 1.1 skrll will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11263 1.1 skrll defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11264 1.1 skrll buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11265 1.1 skrll
11266 1.1 skrll Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11267 1.1 skrll error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11268 1.1 skrll
11269 1.1 skrll int
11270 1.1 skrll bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11271 1.1 skrll {
11272 1.1 skrll int num_phdrs;
11273 1.1 skrll
11274 1.1 skrll if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11275 1.1 skrll {
11276 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11277 1.1 skrll return -1;
11278 1.1 skrll }
11279 1.1 skrll
11280 1.1 skrll num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11281 1.1 skrll memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11282 1.6 christos num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11283 1.6 christos
11284 1.6 christos return num_phdrs;
11285 1.1 skrll }
11286 1.1 skrll
11287 1.1 skrll enum elf_reloc_type_class
11288 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11289 1.1 skrll const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11290 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11291 1.1 skrll {
11292 1.1 skrll return reloc_class_normal;
11293 1.1 skrll }
11294 1.1 skrll
11295 1.1 skrll /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11296 1.1 skrll relocation against a local symbol. */
11297 1.1 skrll
11298 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
11299 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11300 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11301 1.1 skrll asection **psec,
11302 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11303 1.1 skrll {
11304 1.1 skrll asection *sec = *psec;
11305 1.1 skrll bfd_vma relocation;
11306 1.5 christos
11307 1.1 skrll relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11308 1.1 skrll + sec->output_offset
11309 1.1 skrll + sym->st_value);
11310 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11311 1.1 skrll && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11312 1.1 skrll && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11313 1.1 skrll {
11314 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend =
11315 1.1 skrll _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11316 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11317 1.1 skrll sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11318 1.1 skrll if (sec != *psec)
11319 1.1 skrll {
11320 1.1 skrll /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11321 1.1 skrll marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11322 1.1 skrll SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11323 1.1 skrll other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11324 1.1 skrll some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11325 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11326 1.1 skrll sec->kept_section = *psec;
11327 1.1 skrll sec = *psec;
11328 1.1 skrll }
11329 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11330 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11331 1.1 skrll }
11332 1.1 skrll return relocation;
11333 1.1 skrll }
11334 1.1 skrll
11335 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
11336 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11337 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11338 1.1 skrll asection **psec,
11339 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addend)
11340 1.1 skrll {
11341 1.1 skrll asection *sec = *psec;
11342 1.1 skrll
11343 1.1 skrll if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11344 1.1 skrll return sym->st_value + addend;
11345 1.7 christos
11346 1.7 christos return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11347 1.7 christos elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11348 1.7 christos sym->st_value + addend);
11349 1.7 christos }
11350 1.7 christos
11351 1.1 skrll /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11352 1.1 skrll the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11353 1.1 skrll section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11354 1.1 skrll The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11355 1.1 skrll byte may be. */
11356 1.1 skrll
11357 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
11358 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11359 1.5 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
11360 1.1 skrll asection *sec,
11361 1.1 skrll bfd_vma offset)
11362 1.5 christos {
11363 1.1 skrll switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11364 1.7 christos {
11365 1.1 skrll case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11366 1.5 christos return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11367 1.5 christos offset);
11368 1.7 christos case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11369 1.5 christos return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11370 1.5 christos
11371 1.7 christos default:
11372 1.7 christos if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11373 1.7 christos {
11374 1.7 christos /* Reverse the offset. */
11375 1.5 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11376 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11377 1.1 skrll
11378 1.1 skrll /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11379 1.1 skrll to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11380 1.1 skrll offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11381 1.1 skrll }
11382 1.1 skrll return offset;
11383 1.1 skrll }
11384 1.1 skrll }
11385 1.1 skrll
11386 1.1 skrll /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11388 1.1 skrll reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11389 1.1 skrll based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11390 1.1 skrll points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11391 1.1 skrll between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11392 1.1 skrll file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11393 1.1 skrll
11394 1.1 skrll The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11395 1.1 skrll remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11396 1.1 skrll should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11397 1.6 christos be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11398 1.1 skrll the remote memory. */
11399 1.5 christos
11400 1.1 skrll bfd *
11401 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11402 1.6 christos (bfd *templ,
11403 1.1 skrll bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
11404 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type size,
11405 1.1 skrll bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11406 1.1 skrll int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11407 1.1 skrll {
11408 1.1 skrll return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11409 1.1 skrll (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11410 1.1 skrll }
11411 1.1 skrll
11412 1.1 skrll long
11414 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11415 1.1 skrll long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11416 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11417 1.1 skrll long dynsymcount,
11418 1.1 skrll asymbol **dynsyms,
11419 1.1 skrll asymbol **ret)
11420 1.1 skrll {
11421 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11422 1.1 skrll asection *relplt;
11423 1.1 skrll asymbol *s;
11424 1.1 skrll const char *relplt_name;
11425 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11426 1.1 skrll arelent *p;
11427 1.1 skrll long count, i, n;
11428 1.1 skrll size_t size;
11429 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11430 1.1 skrll char *names;
11431 1.1 skrll asection *plt;
11432 1.1 skrll
11433 1.1 skrll *ret = NULL;
11434 1.1 skrll
11435 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11436 1.1 skrll return 0;
11437 1.1 skrll
11438 1.1 skrll if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11439 1.1 skrll return 0;
11440 1.1 skrll
11441 1.1 skrll if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11442 1.1 skrll return 0;
11443 1.1 skrll
11444 1.1 skrll relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11445 1.1 skrll if (relplt_name == NULL)
11446 1.1 skrll relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11447 1.1 skrll relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11448 1.1 skrll if (relplt == NULL)
11449 1.1 skrll return 0;
11450 1.1 skrll
11451 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11452 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11453 1.1 skrll || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11454 1.1 skrll return 0;
11455 1.1 skrll
11456 1.1 skrll plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11457 1.1 skrll if (plt == NULL)
11458 1.1 skrll return 0;
11459 1.1 skrll
11460 1.3 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11461 1.3 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11462 1.3 christos return -1;
11463 1.3 christos
11464 1.3 christos count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11465 1.3 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11466 1.3 christos p = relplt->relocation;
11467 1.3 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11468 1.3 christos {
11469 1.3 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11470 1.3 christos if (p->addend != 0)
11471 1.1 skrll {
11472 1.3 christos #ifdef BFD64
11473 1.1 skrll size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11474 1.1 skrll #else
11475 1.1 skrll size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11476 1.1 skrll #endif
11477 1.1 skrll }
11478 1.1 skrll }
11479 1.1 skrll
11480 1.1 skrll s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11481 1.1 skrll if (s == NULL)
11482 1.1 skrll return -1;
11483 1.1 skrll
11484 1.1 skrll names = (char *) (s + count);
11485 1.1 skrll p = relplt->relocation;
11486 1.1 skrll n = 0;
11487 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11488 1.1 skrll {
11489 1.1 skrll size_t len;
11490 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addr;
11491 1.1 skrll
11492 1.1 skrll addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11493 1.1 skrll if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11494 1.1 skrll continue;
11495 1.1 skrll
11496 1.1 skrll *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11497 1.1 skrll /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11498 1.1 skrll we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11499 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11500 1.1 skrll s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11501 1.3 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11502 1.3 christos s->section = plt;
11503 1.3 christos s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11504 1.5 christos s->name = names;
11505 1.3 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
11506 1.3 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11507 1.3 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11508 1.3 christos names += len;
11509 1.3 christos if (p->addend != 0)
11510 1.3 christos {
11511 1.3 christos char buf[30], *a;
11512 1.3 christos
11513 1.3 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11514 1.1 skrll names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11515 1.1 skrll bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11516 1.1 skrll for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11517 1.1 skrll ;
11518 1.1 skrll len = strlen (a);
11519 1.1 skrll memcpy (names, a, len);
11520 1.1 skrll names += len;
11521 1.1 skrll }
11522 1.9 christos memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11523 1.9 christos names += sizeof ("@plt");
11524 1.9 christos ++s, ++n;
11525 1.9 christos }
11526 1.9 christos
11527 1.1 skrll return n;
11528 1.9 christos }
11529 1.9 christos
11530 1.1 skrll /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11531 1.1 skrll ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11532 1.6 christos but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11533 1.6 christos static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11534 1.1 skrll = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11535 1.1 skrll asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11536 1.1 skrll = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11537 1.1 skrll "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11538 1.1 skrll
11539 1.1 skrll void
11540 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11541 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11542 1.5 christos {
11543 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11544 1.3 christos
11545 1.3 christos i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11546 1.5 christos
11547 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11548 1.1 skrll
11549 1.1 skrll /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11550 1.1 skrll osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11551 1.1 skrll the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11552 1.3 christos if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11553 1.1 skrll && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11554 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11555 1.1 skrll }
11556 1.1 skrll
11557 1.3 christos
11558 1.3 christos /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11559 1.1 skrll This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11560 1.5 christos most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11561 1.5 christos
11562 1.5 christos bfd_boolean
11563 1.5 christos _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11564 1.5 christos {
11565 1.5 christos return (type == STT_FUNC
11566 1.5 christos || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11567 1.5 christos }
11568 1.5 christos
11569 1.5 christos /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11570 1.5 christos function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11571 1.5 christos otherwise return zero. */
11572 1.5 christos
11573 1.5 christos bfd_size_type
11574 1.5 christos _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11575 1.5 christos bfd_vma *code_off)
11576 1.5 christos {
11577 1.5 christos bfd_size_type size;
11578 1.5 christos
11579 1.5 christos if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11580 1.5 christos | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11581 1.5 christos || sym->section != sec)
11582 1.5 christos return 0;
11583 1.5 christos
11584 *code_off = sym->value;
11585 size = 0;
11586 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11587 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
11588 if (size == 0)
11589 size = 1;
11590 return size;
11591 }
11592